# SOME DESCRIPTIVE TITLE
# Copyright (C) YEAR Mageia
# This file is distributed under the same license as the Mageia Control Center Help package.
# FIRST AUTHOR <EMAIL@ADDRESS>, YEAR.
#
#, fuzzy
msgid ""
msgstr ""
"Project-Id-Version: Mageia Control Center Help 4.0\n"
"Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: doc-discuss@ml.mageia.org\n"
"POT-Creation-Date: 2017-05-23 19:46+0300\n"
"PO-Revision-Date: YEAR-MO-DA HO:MI+ZONE\n"
"Last-Translator: FULL NAME <EMAIL@ADDRESS>\n"
"Language-Team: LANGUAGE <LL@li.org>\n"
"Language: \n"
"MIME-Version: 1.0\n"
"Content-Type: text/plain; charset=UTF-8\n"
"Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit\n"

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:11
msgid "Access WebDAV shared drives and directories"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:14
msgid "diskdrake --dav"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:19
msgid "diskdrake--dav1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:24
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake --dav</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:24
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found in the Mageia "
"Control Center, under the Network Sharing tab, labeled <guilabel>Configure "
"WebDAV shares</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:30 en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:22 en/diskdrake--smb.xml:21 en/drak3d.xml:15 en/drakconnect.xml:16 en/draknetcenter.xml:29 en/draksambashare.xml:27 en/drakvpn.xml:16 en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:27 en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:41 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:27 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:46 en/keyboarddrake.xml:17 en/system-config-printer.xml:21
msgid "Introduction"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:32
msgid ""
"<link xlink:href=\"http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/WebDAV\">WebDAV</link> is a "
"protocol that allows to mount a web server's directory locally, so that it "
"appears as a local directory. It is necessary that the remote machine run a "
"WebDAV server. This is not the aim of this tool to configure the WebDAV "
"server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:40
msgid "Creating a new entry"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:42
msgid ""
"The first screen of the tool displays the already configured entries, if "
"any, and a <guibutton>New</guibutton> button. Use it to create a new "
"entry. Insert the server URL in the field of the new screen."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:46
msgid ""
"Then you get a screen with radio buttons to select some actions.  Continue "
"with the action <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> by clicking "
"<guibutton>OK</guibutton> after selecting the radio button, as the "
"<guibutton>Server</guibutton> is already configured. You can however correct "
"it, if needed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:54
msgid "diskdrake--dav3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:58
msgid ""
"The content of the remote directory will be accessible through this mount "
"point."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:61
msgid ""
"In the next step, give your user name and password. If you need some other "
"options, you can give them in the <guibutton>advanced</guibutton> screen."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:67
msgid "diskdrake--dav4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:71
msgid ""
"The option <guibutton>Mount</guibutton> allows you to mount immediately the "
"access."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--dav.xml:74
msgid ""
"After you accepted the configuration with the radio button "
"<guibutton>Done</guibutton>, the first screen is displayed again and your "
"new mount point is listed. After you choose <guibutton>Quit</guibutton>, you "
"are asked whether or not to save the modifications in "
"<emphasis>/etc/fstab</emphasis>. Choose this option if you want that the "
"remote directory is available at each boot. If your configuration is for "
"one-time usage, do not save it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:3
msgid "Share your hard disk partitions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:6
msgid "diskdrake --fileshare"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:11
msgid "diskdrake--fileshare.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake --fileshare</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:15
msgid ""
"This simple tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you, the "
"administrator, to allow users to share parts of their own /home "
"subdirectories with other users of a same local network which may have "
"computers running either Linux or Windows operating system."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:20
msgid ""
"It is found in the Mageia Control Center, under the Local Disk tab, labelled "
"\"Share your hard disk partitions\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:23
msgid ""
"First, answer the question : \"<guilabel>Would you like to allow users to "
"share some of their directories ?</guilabel>\", click on <guibutton>No "
"sharing</guibutton> if the answer is no for all users, click on "
"<guibutton>Allow all users</guibutton> for all users and click on "
"<guibutton>Custom</guibutton> if the answer is no for some users and yes for "
"the others. In this last case, the users that are authorised to share their "
"directories must belong to the fileshare group, which is automatically "
"created by the system. You will be asked about this later."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:32
msgid ""
"Click on <guilabel>OK</guilabel>, a second screen appears which asks you "
"choose between <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> or <guibutton>SMB</guibutton>.  "
"Check <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> if Linux is the only operating system on "
"the network, check <guibutton>SMB</guibutton> if the network includes both "
"Linux and Windows machines and then click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Any "
"required packages will be installed if necessary."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:39
msgid ""
"The configuration is now complete unless the Custom option was chosen.  In "
"this case, an extra screen prompts you to open Userdrake. This tool allows "
"you to add users authorised to share their directories to the fileshare "
"group. In the User tab, click on the user to add to the fileshare group, "
"then on <guimenuitem>Edit</guimenuitem>, In the Groups tab. Check the "
"fileshare group and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. For more information "
"about Userdrake, see <link ns2:href=\"userdrake.xml\">this page</link>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:50
msgid ""
"When adding a new user to the fileshare group, you have to disconnect and "
"reconnect the network for the modifications to be taken into account."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--fileshare.xml:55
msgid ""
"From now on each user belonging to the fileshare group can select in his/her "
"file manager the directories to be shared, although not all file managers "
"have this facility."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'xml:lang' of: <section>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:1 en/MCC-cover.xml:9 en/mcc-network.xml:1 en/MCC.xml:1 en/software-management.xml:2 en/transfugdrake.xml:1
msgid "en"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:3
msgid "Access NFS shared drives and directories"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:6
msgid "diskdrake --nfs"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:11
msgid "diskdrake--nfs.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:17
msgid "."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:25
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake --nfs</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:24
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you to declare "
"some shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The "
"protocol used for this is NFS which is available on most Linux or Unix "
"systems. The shared directory will be thus available directly at "
"boot. Shared directories can be also accessible directly in a single session "
"for a user with tools such as file browsers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:36 en/diskdrake--smb.xml:38
msgid "Procedure"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:38
msgid ""
"Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers "
"which share directories."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:41
msgid ""
"Click on the > symbol before the server name to display the list of the "
"shared directories and select the directory you want to access."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:47
msgid "diskdrake--nfs2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:51
msgid ""
"The button <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> will be available and you have "
"to specify where to mount the directory."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:56
msgid "diskdrake--nfs3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:60
msgid ""
"After choosing the mount point, You can mount it. You can also verify and "
"change some options with the <guibutton>Options</guibutton> button. After "
"mounting the directory, you can unmount it with the same button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:67
msgid "diskdrake--nfs4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:73
msgid "diskdrake--nfs5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:77
msgid ""
"On accepting the configuration with the <guibutton>Done</guibutton> button, "
"a message will displayed, asking \"Do you want to save the /etc/fstab "
"modifications\". This will make the directory available at each boot, if the "
"network is accessible. The new directory is then available in your file "
"browser, for example in Dolphin."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--nfs.xml:85
msgid "diskdrake--nfs6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:3
msgid "CD/DVD burner"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:5
msgid "diskdrake --removable"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:10
msgid "diskdrake--removable.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake --removable</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool <placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/>is found under the tab "
"Local disks in the Mageia Control Center labelled accordingly with your "
"removable hardware (CD/DVD players and burners and floppy drives only)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:20
msgid "Its goal is to define the way your removable disk is mounted."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:22
msgid ""
"At the top of the window there is a short description of your hardware and "
"the chosen options to mount it. Use the menu on the bottom to change "
"them. Check the item to be changed and then on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> "
"button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:28
msgid "Mount point"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:30
msgid "Check this box to change the mount point. The default one is /media/cdrom."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><bridgehead>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:37 en/harddrake2.xml:66
msgid "Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:39
msgid ""
"Many mount options can be chosen here either directly in the list or via the "
"<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel> submenu. The main are:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:45
msgid "user/nouser"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--removable.xml:47
msgid ""
"user allows an ordinary user (not root) to mount the removable disk, this "
"option involves noexec, nosuid and nodev. The user who mounted the disk is "
"the only one who can umount it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:11
msgid "Access Windows (SMB) shared drives and directories"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:14
msgid "diskdrake --smb"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:24
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake --smb</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:23
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you to declare "
"which shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The "
"protocol used for this is SMB which has been popularized on Windows(R) "
"systems. The shared directory will be available directly at boot. Shared "
"directories can be also accessed directly in a single session by a user with "
"tools such as file browsers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:33
msgid ""
"Before starting the tool, it is a good idea to declare the names of "
"available servers, for example with <xref linkend=\"drakhosts\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:40
msgid ""
"Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers who "
"share directories."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:43
msgid ""
"Click on the server name and on &gt; before the server name to display the "
"list of the shared directories and select the directory you want to access."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:47
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> button will become available, you "
"have to specify where to mount the directory."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:52
msgid "diskdrake--smb2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:56
msgid ""
"After choosing the mount point, it can be mounted with the <guimenu>Mount "
"button</guimenu>. You can also verify and change some options with the "
"<guibutton>Options</guibutton> button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:60
msgid ""
"In options, you can specify the user name and the password of those able to "
"connect to the SMB server. After mounting the directory, you can unmount it "
"with the same button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:66
msgid "diskdrake--smb3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:72
msgid "diskdrake--smb4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:76
msgid ""
"After accepting the configuration with the Done button, a message will ask "
"\"Do you want to save the /etc/fstab modifications\". Saving, will allow "
"directory to made available at each boot, if the network is accessible. The "
"new directory is then available in your file browser, for example in "
"dolphin."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/diskdrake--smb.xml:84
msgid "diskdrake--smb5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drak3d.xml:3
msgid "3D Desktop Effects"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drak3d.xml:5
msgid "drak3d"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drak3d.xml:10
msgid "drak3d.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:18
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drak3d</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:17
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> lets you manage the 3D "
"desktop effects on your operating system. 3D effects are turned off by "
"default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drak3d.xml:25
msgid "Getting Started"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:27
msgid ""
"To use this tool, you need to have the glxinfo package installed. If the "
"package is not installed, you will be prompted to do so before drak3d can "
"start."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:31
msgid ""
"After starting drak3d, you will be presented with a menu window.  Here you "
"can choose either <guilabel>No 3D Desktop Effects</guilabel> or "
"<guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel>. Compiz Fusion is part of a "
"composite/window manager, which includes hardware-accelerated special "
"effects for your desktop. Choose <guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel> to turn "
"it on."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:38
msgid ""
"If this is your first time using this program after a clean installation of "
"Mageia, you will get a warning message telling you which packages need to be "
"installed in order to use Compiz Fusion. Click on the "
"<guibutton>Ok</guibutton> button to continue."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drak3d.xml:45
msgid "drak3d_installing_CompizFusion.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:49
msgid ""
"Once the appropriate packages are installed, you will notice that Compiz "
"Fusion is selected in the drak3d menu, but you must log out and log back in "
"for the changes to take effect."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:53
msgid ""
"After logging back in, Compiz Fusion will be activated. To configure Compiz "
"Fusion, see the page for the ccsm (CompizConfig Settings Manager)  tool."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drak3d.xml:59
msgid "Troubleshooting"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/drak3d.xml:62
msgid "Can't See Desktop after Logging in"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:64
msgid ""
"If after turning on Compiz Fusion you attempt to log back into your desktop "
"but can't see anything, restart your computer to get back to the log in "
"screen. Once there, click on the Desktop icon and select drak3d."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drak3d.xml:71
msgid "drak3d_troubleshooting_login_option.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/drak3d.xml:75
msgid ""
"When you log in, if your account is listed as an administrator, you will be "
"prompted for your password again. Otherwise, use the administrator login "
"with his/her account. Then you can undo any changes that may have caused the "
"log in problem."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakauth.xml:9
msgid "Authentication"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakauth.xml:11
msgid "drakauth"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakauth.xml:16
msgid "drakauth.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakauth.xml:21
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakauth</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakauth.xml:21
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> enables you to modify the "
"manner in which you can be recognized as user of the machine or on the net."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakauth.xml:25
msgid ""
"By default, information for your authentication is stored in a file on your "
"computer. Modify it only if your network administrator invites you to do so "
"and give information about that."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:3
msgid "Set up autologin to automatically log in"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:6
msgid "drakautologin"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:11
msgid "drakautologin.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakautologin</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you to "
"automatically login the same user, in her/his desktop environment, without "
"asking for any password. It's called autologin.  This is generally a good "
"idea when there is only one user like to be using the machine."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:22
msgid ""
"It is found under the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Boot</emphasis> tab in the "
"Mageia Control Center labelled \"Set up autologin to automatically log in\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:26
msgid "The interface buttons are pretty obvious:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:28
msgid ""
"Check <guibutton>Launch the graphical environment when your system "
"starts</guibutton>, if you want X Window System to be executed after the "
"boot. If not, the system will start in text mode. Nevertheless, it will be "
"possible to launch the graphic interface manually. This can be done by "
"launching the command 'startx' or 'systemctl start dm'."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakautologin.xml:34
msgid ""
"If the first box is checked, two other options are available, check either "
"<guibutton>No, I don't want autologin</guibutton>, if you want the system to "
"continue to ask for which user to connect (and password) or check "
"<guibutton>Yes, I want autologin with this (user, desktop)</guibutton>, if "
"needed. In this case, you also need to supply the <guilabel>Default "
"username</guilabel> and the <guilabel>Default desktop</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakboot.xml:3
msgid "Set up boot system"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakboot.xml:5
msgid "drakboot"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:10
msgid "drakboot--boot.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:14
msgid ""
"If you are using a UEFI system instead of BIOS, the user interface is "
"slightly different as the boot device is obviously the EFI system Partition "
"(ESP)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:20
msgid "drakboot--boot2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:25
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakboot</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:24
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you to configure "
"the boot options (choice of the bootloader, set a password, the default "
"boot, etc.)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:29
msgid ""
"It is found under the Boot tab in the Mageia Control Center labeled \"Set up "
"boot system\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:33
msgid ""
"Don't use this tool if you don't know exactly what you are doing.  Changing "
"some settings may prevent your machine from booting again !"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:38
msgid ""
"In the first part, called <guilabel>Bootloader</guilabel>, it is possible if "
"using BIOS, to choose which <guibutton>Bootloader to use</guibutton>, Grub, "
"Grub2 or Lilo, and with a graphical or a text menu.  It is just a question "
"of taste, there are no other consequences. You can also set the "
"<guibutton>Boot device</guibutton>, don't change anything here unless you "
"are an expert. The boot device is where the bootloader is installed and any "
"modification can prevent your machine from booting."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:46
msgid ""
"In a UEFI system, the bootloader is <guilabel>Grub2-efi</guilabel> and is "
"installed in /boot/EFI partition. This FAT32 formatted partition is common "
"to all operating systems installed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:50
msgid ""
"In the second part, called <guilabel>Main options</guilabel>, you can set "
"the <guibutton>Delay before booting default image</guibutton>, in "
"seconds. During this delay, Grub or Lilo will display the list of available "
"operating systems, prompting you to make your choice. If no selection is "
"made, the bootloader will boot the default one once the delay elapses."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:57
msgid ""
"In the third and last part, called <guibutton>Security</guibutton>, it is "
"possible to set a password for the bootloader. This means a username and "
"password will be asked at the boot time to select a booting entry or change "
"settings. The username is \"root\" and the password is the one chosen here."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:63
msgid "The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button gives some extra options."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:66
msgid "<guibutton>Enable ACPI:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:68
msgid ""
"ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Power Interface) is a standard for the "
"power management. It can save energy by stopping unused devices, this was "
"the method used before APM. Check this box if your hardware is ACPI "
"compatible."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:73
msgid "<guibutton>Enable SMP:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:75
msgid ""
"SMP stands for Symmetric Multi Processors, it's an architecture for "
"multicore processors."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:79
msgid ""
"If you have a processor with HyperThreading, Mageia will see it as a dual "
"processor and enable SMP."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:83
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Enable APIC</guibutton> and <guibutton>Enable Local "
"APIC:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:86
msgid ""
"APIC stands for Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller. There are two "
"components in the Intel APIC system, the local APIC (LAPIC) and the I/O "
"APIC. The latter one routes the interrupts it receives from peripheral buses "
"to one or more local APICs that are in the processor. It is really useful "
"for multi-processor systems. Some computers have problems with the APIC "
"system which can cause freezes or incorrect device detection (error message "
"\"spurious 8259A interrupt: IRQ7\"). In this case, disable APIC and/or Local "
"APIC."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:97
msgid "drakboot1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:101
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Next</guibutton> screen differs depending on which boot "
"loader you chose."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:106
msgid "You have Grub Legacy or Lilo:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:108
msgid ""
"In this case, you can see the list of all the available entries at boot "
"time. The default one is asterisked. To change the order of the menu "
"entries, click on the up or down arrows to move the selected item.  If you "
"click on the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> or <guibutton>Modify</guibutton> "
"buttons, a new window appears to add a new entry in the bootloader menu or "
"to modify an existing one. You need to be familiar with Lilo or Grub to be "
"able to use these tools."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:118
msgid "drakboot2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:122
msgid ""
"The <guilabel>Label</guilabel> field is freeform, write here what you want "
"to be displayed in the menu. It matches the Grub command \"title\". For "
"example: Mageia3."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:126
msgid ""
"The <guilabel>Image</guilabel> field contains the kernel name. It matches "
"the Grub command \"kernel\". For example /boot/vmlinuz."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:129
msgid ""
"The <guilabel>Root</guilabel> field contains the device name where the "
"kernel is stored. It matches the Grub command \"root\". For example (hd0,1)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:133 en/drakboot.xml:160
msgid ""
"The <guilabel>Append</guilabel> field contains the options to be given to "
"the kernel at boot time."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:136
msgid ""
"If the box <guilabel>Default</guilabel> is checked, Grub will boot this "
"entry by default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:139
msgid ""
"In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to "
"choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>, an <guilabel>initrd</guilabel> "
"file and a <guilabel>network profile</guilabel>, see <xref "
"linkend=\"draknetprofile\"/>, in the drop-down lists."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:147
msgid ""
"You have Grub2 or Grub2-efi (boot loaders used by default respectively in "
"Legacy mode and UEFI mode):"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:150
msgid ""
"In this case, the drop-down list labelled <guilabel>Default</guilabel> "
"displays all the available entries; click on the one wanted as the default "
"one."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:156
msgid "drakboot3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:163
msgid ""
"If you have other operating systems installed, Mageia attempts to add them "
"to your Mageia boot menu. If you don't want this behaviour, uncheck the box "
"<guilabel>Probe Foreign OS</guilabel>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:167
msgid ""
"In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to "
"choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>. If you don't want a bootable "
"Mageia, but to chain load it from another OS, check the box <guilabel>Do not "
"touch ESP or MBR</guilabel> and accept the warning."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:175
msgid "drakboot6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><warning><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:180
msgid ""
"Not installing on ESP or MBR means that the installation is not bootable "
"unless chain loaded from another OS."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakboot.xml:184
msgid ""
"To set many other parameters, you can use the tool named <emphasis>Grub "
"Customizer</emphasis>, available in the Mageia repositories (see below)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakboot.xml:190
msgid "drakboot4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:11
msgid "Collect Logs and System Information for Bug Reports"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:12
msgid "drakbug_report"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakbug_report</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can only be started and "
"used on the command line."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:20
msgid ""
"It is advised to write the output of this command to a file, for instance by "
"doing <emphasis role=\"bold\">drakbug_report > drakbugreport.txt</emphasis>, "
"but make sure you have enough disk space first: the file can easily be "
"several GBs large."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:24
msgid ""
"The output is far too large to attach to a bug report without first removing "
"the unneeded parts."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:26
msgid "This command collects the following information on your system:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:29
msgid "lspci"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:30
msgid "pci_devices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:31
msgid "dmidecode"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:32
msgid "fdisk"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:33
msgid "scsi"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:34
msgid "/sys/bus/scsi/devices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:35
msgid "lsmod"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:36
msgid "cmdline"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:37
msgid "pcmcia: stab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:38
msgid "usb"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:39
msgid "partitions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:40
msgid "cpuinfo"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:41
msgid "syslog"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:42
msgid "Xorg.log"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:43
msgid "monitor_full_edid"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:44
msgid "stage1.log"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:45
msgid "ddebug.log"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:46
msgid "install.log"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:47
msgid "fstab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:48
msgid "modprobe.conf"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:49
msgid "lilo.conf"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:50
msgid "grub: menu.lst"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:51
msgid "grub: install.sh"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:52
msgid "grub: device.map"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:53
msgid "xorg.conf"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:54
msgid "urpmi.cfg"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:55
msgid "modprobe.preload"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:56
msgid "sysconfig/i18n"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:57
msgid "/proc/iomem"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:58
msgid "/proc/ioport"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:59
msgid "mageia version"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:60
msgid "rpm -qa"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:61
msgid "df"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakbug_report.xml:65
msgid ""
"At the time this help page was written, the \"syslog\" part of this "
"command's output was empty, because this tool had not yet been adjusted to "
"our switch to systemd. If it is still empty, you can retrieve the \"syslog\" "
"by doing (as root) <emphasis role=\"bold\"> journalctl -a > "
"journalctl.txt</emphasis>. If you don't have a lot of diskspace, you can, "
"for instance, take the last 5000 lines of the log instead with: <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">journalctl -a | tail -n5000 > journalctl5000.txt</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakbug.xml:9
msgid "Mageia Bug Report Tool"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakbug.xml:9
msgid "drakbug"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakbug.xml:15
msgid "drakbug.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakbug.xml:19
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakbug</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug.xml:19
msgid ""
"Usually, this tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> starts "
"automatically when a Mageia tool crashes. However, it is also possible that, "
"after filing a bug report, you are asked to start this tool to check some of "
"the information it gives, and then provide that in that existing bug report."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug.xml:21
msgid ""
"If a new bug report needs to be filed and you are not used to doing that, "
"then please read <link "
"xlink:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/How_to_report_a_bug_properly\">How "
"to report a bug report properly</link> before clicking on the \"Report\" "
"button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakbug.xml:23
msgid ""
"In case the bug has already been filed by someone else (the error message "
"that drakbug gave will be the same, then), it is useful to add a comment to "
"that existing report that you saw the bug, too."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakclock.xml:3
msgid "Manage date and time"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakclock.xml:5
msgid "drakclock"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakclock.xml:10
msgid "drakclock.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakclock</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found under the tab "
"System in the Mageia Control Center labelled <guilabel>\"Manage date and "
"time\"</guilabel>. In some desktop environments it is also available by a "
"right click / Adjust date and Time ... on the clock in the system tray."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:21
msgid "It's a very simple tool."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:23
msgid ""
"On the upper left part, is the <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">calendar</emphasis>. On the screenshot above, the date is "
"September (on the upper left), 2012 (on the upper right), the 2nd (in blue)  "
"and it is a Sunday. Select the month (or year) by clicking on the little "
"arrows on each side of September (or 2012). Select the day by clicking on "
"its number."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:29
msgid ""
"On the bottom left is the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Network Time "
"Protocol</emphasis> synchronising, it is possible to have a clock always on "
"time by synchronising it with a server. Check <guilabel>Enable Network Time "
"Protocol</guilabel> and choose the closest server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:34
msgid ""
"On the right part is the <emphasis role=\"bold\">clock</emphasis>. It's "
"useless to set the clock if NTP is enabled. Three boxes display hours, "
"minutes and seconds (15, 28 and 22 on the screenshot). Use the little arrows "
"to set the clock to the correct time. The format can't be changed here, see "
"your desktop environment settings for that."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:40
msgid ""
"At least, on the bottom right, select your time zone by clicking on the "
"<guibutton>Change Time Zone</guibutton> button and choosing in the list the "
"nearest town."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakclock.xml:45
msgid ""
"Even if it isn't possible to choose a date or time format in this tool, they "
"will be displayed on your desktop in accordance with the localisation "
"settings."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:3
msgid "Remove a connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:3
msgid "drakconnect --del"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:8
msgid "drakconnect--del.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:12
msgid ""
"You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakconnect --del</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:12
msgid ""
"Here, you can delete a network interface<placeholder type=\"footnote\" "
"id=\"0\"/>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:14
msgid ""
"Click on the drop down menu, choose the one you want to remove and then "
"click <emphasis>next</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakconnect--del.xml:15
msgid ""
"You'll see a message that the network interface has been deleted "
"successfully."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:3
msgid "Set up a new network interface (LAN, ISDN, ADSL, ...)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:6
msgid "drakconnect"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:11
msgid "drakconnect.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:19
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakconnect</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:18
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows to configure much "
"of local network or Internet access. You have to know some information from "
"your access provider or your network administrator."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:25
msgid ""
"Select the type of connection you want to set, according to which hardware "
"and provider you have."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:30
msgid "A new Wired connection (Ethernet)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:34 en/drakconnect.xml:162
msgid ""
"The first window lists the interfaces which are available.  Select the one "
"to configure."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:39 en/drakconnect.xml:167
msgid ""
"At this point, the choice is given between an automatic or a manual IP "
"address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:44 en/drakconnect.xml:187 en/drakconnect.xml:557
msgid "Automatic IP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:48
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers "
"are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained "
"below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The "
"HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified, "
"the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.  "
"The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option "
"<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers "
"have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address "
"from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:62
msgid "drakconnect5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:68 en/drakconnect.xml:205 en/drakconnect.xml:572
msgid "The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:72 en/drakconnect.xml:209 en/drakconnect.xml:576
msgid "Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:77 en/drakconnect.xml:214 en/drakconnect.xml:581
msgid "the DHCP client"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:81 en/drakconnect.xml:218 en/drakconnect.xml:585
msgid "DHCP timeout"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:85 en/drakconnect.xml:222
msgid "Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:90 en/drakconnect.xml:227 en/drakconnect.xml:594
msgid "Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:95 en/drakconnect.xml:232 en/drakconnect.xml:599
msgid ""
"the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server "
"requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP "
"address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:104 en/drakconnect.xml:241
msgid ""
"After accepting, the last steps which are common to all connection "
"configurations are explained: <xref linkend=\"drakconnect-end\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:111 en/drakconnect.xml:248 en/drakconnect.xml:615
msgid "Manual configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:115
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS "
"servers to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no "
"HOSTNAME is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is "
"attributed by default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:121 en/drakconnect.xml:258
msgid ""
"For a residential network, the IP address usually looks like "
"<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is "
"<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are "
"available from your service provider's website."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:126
msgid ""
"In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search "
"domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your "
"computer is called \"splash\", and it's full domain name is "
"\"splash.boatanchor.net\", the Search Domain would be "
"\"boatanchor.net\". Unless you specifically need it, it's ok not to define "
"this setting. Again, domestic ADSL would not need this setting."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:136
msgid "drakconnect30.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:142 en/drakconnect.xml:279 en/drakconnect.xml:351 en/drakconnect.xml:458 en/drakconnect.xml:636 en/drakconnect.xml:688 en/drakconnect.xml:780
msgid "The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend=\"drakconnect-end\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:150
msgid "A new Satellite connection (DVB)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:152 en/drakconnect.xml:696 en/draknetcenter.xml:136 en/draknetcenter.xml:142 en/draknetcenter.xml:203
msgid ""
"This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you "
"can write this help, please contact <link "
"ns2:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team\"> the Doc "
"team.</link> Thanking you in advance."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:158
msgid "A new Cable modem connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:172
msgid "You have to specify a authentication method:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:176
msgid "None"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:180
msgid ""
"BPALogin (necessary for Telstra). In this case you have to provide User name "
"and password."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:191
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers "
"are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained "
"below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The "
"HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified, "
"the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.  "
"The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option "
"<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers "
"have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address "
"from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:252
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS servers "
"to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME "
"is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is "
"attributed by default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:263
msgid ""
"In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search "
"domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your "
"computer is called \"splash\", and it's full domain name is "
"\"splash.boatanchor.net\", the Search Domain would be "
"\"boatanchor.net\". Unless you specifically need it, it's ok not to define "
"this setting. Again, domestic connection would not need this setting."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:273
msgid "drakconnect32.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:287
msgid "A new DSL connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:291
msgid ""
"If the tool detects network interfaces, it offers to select one and to "
"configure it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:296 en/drakconnect.xml:663
msgid ""
"A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries.  Select your "
"provider. If it is not listed, select the option "
"<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:303 en/drakconnect.xml:380
msgid "Select one of the protocols available:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:307
msgid "Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:311
msgid "Manual TCP/IP configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:315
msgid "PPP over ADSL (PPPoA)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:319
msgid "PPP over Ethernet (PPPoE)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:323
msgid "Point to Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:329
msgid "Access settings"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:333 en/drakconnect.xml:678
msgid "Account Login (user name)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:337 en/drakconnect.xml:414 en/drakconnect.xml:682
msgid "Account password"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:341
msgid "(Advanced) Virtual Path ID (VPI)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:345
msgid "(Advanced) Virtual Circuit ID (VCI)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:289 en/drakconnect.xml:359 en/drakconnect.xml:646
msgid "<placeholder type=\"orderedlist\" id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:357
msgid "A new ISDN connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:361 en/drakconnect.xml:706
msgid "The wizard asks which device to configure:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:365
msgid "Manual choice (internal ISDN card)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:369
msgid "External ISDN modem"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:375
msgid ""
"A list of hardware is proposed, classified by category and "
"manufacturer. Select your card."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:384
msgid "Protocol for the rest of the world, except Europe (DHCP)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:389
msgid "Protocol for Europe (EDSS1)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:395
msgid ""
"A list of providers is then offered, classified by countries.  Select your "
"provider. If it is not listed, select the option "
"<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave "
"you. Then it is asked for parameters:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:402
msgid "Connection name"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:406
msgid "Phone number"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:410
msgid "Login ID"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:418
msgid "Authentication method"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:424
msgid ""
"After that, you have to select if you get the IP address by automatic or "
"manual method. In the last case, specify IP address and Subnet mask."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:430
msgid ""
"The next step is to choose how DNS servers address are obtained, by "
"automatic or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to "
"put:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:436
msgid "Domain name"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:440
msgid "First and second DNS Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:444
msgid ""
"Select if the hostname is set from IP. This option is to select only if you "
"are sure that your provider is configured to accept it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:452
msgid ""
"The next step is to choose how the gateway address is obtained, by automatic "
"or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to enter the "
"IP address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:464
msgid "A new Wireless connection (WiFi)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:468
msgid ""
"A first window lists the interfaces which are available and an entry for "
"Windows driver (ndiswrapper). Select the one to configure.  Use ndiswrapper "
"only if the other configuration methods did not work."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:475
msgid ""
"At this step, the choice is given between the different access points that "
"the card has detected."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:480
msgid "Specific parameter for the wireless card are to provide:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:484
msgid "drakconnect31.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:490
msgid "Operating mode:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><term>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:494
msgid "Managed"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:497
msgid "To access to an existing access point (the most frequent)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><term>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:503
msgid "Ad-Hoc"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:506
msgid "To configure direct connection between computers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:514
msgid "Network Name (ESSID)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:518
msgid "Encryption mode: it depends of how the access point is configured."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><term>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:523
msgid "WPA/WPA2"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:526
msgid "This encryption mode is to prefer if your hardware allows it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><term>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:532
msgid "WEP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:535
msgid "Some old hardware deals only this encryption method."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:543
msgid "Encryption key"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:545
msgid "It is generally provided with the hardware which give the access point."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:552
msgid ""
"At this step, the choice is given between an automatic IP address or a "
"manual IP address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:561
msgid ""
"<emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers are "
"declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained "
"below. In the last case, IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The "
"HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here.  If no HOSTNAME is "
"specified, the name localhost.localdomain is attributed by default. The "
"Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option "
"<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:589
msgid "Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS servers"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:608
msgid ""
"After accepting the configuration the step, which is common to all "
"connection configurations, is explained: <xref linkend=\"drakconnect-end\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:619
msgid ""
"<emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to declare DNS servers. The "
"HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified, "
"the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:625
msgid ""
"For a residential network, the IP address always looks like "
"<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is "
"<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are "
"available from your providers website."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:630
msgid ""
"In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search "
"domain</emphasis>. It must seem to your hostname without the first name, "
"before the period."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:644
msgid "A new GPRS/Edge/3G connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:648
msgid ""
"If the tool detects wireless interfaces, it offers to select one and to "
"configure it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:653
msgid "The PIN is asked. Leave empty if the PIN is not required."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:658
msgid ""
"The wizard asks for network. If it is not detected, select the option "
"<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:670
msgid "Provide access settings"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:674
msgid "Access Point Name"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:694
msgid "A new Bluetooth Dial-Up Networking connection"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:702
msgid "A new Analog telephone modem connection (POTS)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:710
msgid "Manual choice"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:714
msgid "Detected hardware, if any."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:720
msgid "A list of ports is proposed. Select your port."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:724
msgid ""
"If not yet installed, it will be suggested that you install the package "
"<emphasis>kppp-provider</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:729
msgid ""
"A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your "
"provider. If it is not listed, select the option "
"<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider "
"gave. Then it is asked for Dialup options:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:736
msgid "<emphasis>Connection name</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:740
msgid "<emphasis>Phone number</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:744
msgid "<emphasis>Login ID</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:748
msgid "<emphasis>Password</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:752
msgid "<emphasis>Authentication</emphasis>, choose between:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:756
msgid "PAP/CHAP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:760
msgid "Script-based"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:764
msgid "PAP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:768
msgid "Terminal-based"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:772
msgid "CHAP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:786
msgid "Ending the configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:788
msgid "In the next step, you can specify:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:792
msgid "<emphasis>Allow users to manage the connection</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:796
msgid "<emphasis>Start the connection at boot</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:800
msgid "<emphasis>Enable traffic accounting</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:804
msgid "<emphasis>Allow interface to be controlled by Network Manager</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:809
msgid ""
"In the case of a wireless connection, a supplemental box is <emphasis>Allow "
"access point roaming</emphasis> which give the possibility to switch "
"automatically between access point according to the signal strength."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:816
msgid "With the advanced button, you can specify:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:820
msgid "Metric (10 by default)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:824
msgid "MTU"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:828
msgid "Network Hotplugging"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:832
msgid "Enable IPv6 to IPv4 tunnel"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:836
msgid ""
"The last step allows you to specify if the connection is to start "
"immediately or not."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconnect.xml:841
msgid "drakconnect9.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakconsole.xml:3
msgid "Open a console as administrator"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakconsole.xml:5
msgid "drakconsole"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakconsole.xml:10
msgid "drakconsole.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakconsole.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakconsole</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakconsole.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> gives you access to a "
"console which is directly opened as root. We do not think that you need more "
"information about that."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:5
msgid "Manage disk partitions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:7
msgid "drakdisk or diskdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:12
msgid "drakdiskBackup.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:18
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakdisk</emphasis> or <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">diskdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:17
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is very powerful, a tiny "
"error or a cat jumping on your keyboard can lead to losing all data on a "
"partition or even to erasing the entire hard disk. For that reason, you'll "
"see the screen above on top of the tool screen. Click on "
"<emphasis>Exit</emphasis> if you're not sure you want to continue."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:27
msgid ""
"If you have more than one hard disk, you can switch to the hard disk you "
"want to work on by selecting the correct tab (sda, sdb, sdc etc)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:32
msgid "drakdisk.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:36
msgid ""
"You can choose from many actions to adjust your hard disk to your "
"preferences. Wiping an entire hard disk, splitting or merging partitions, "
"resizing them or changing the filesystem, formatting or viewing what is in a "
"partition: it is all possible. The <emphasis><guibutton>Clear "
"all</guibutton></emphasis> button at the bottom is to erase the complete "
"disk, the other buttons become visible on the right after you click on a "
"partition."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:47
msgid ""
"If you have an UEFI system, you can see a small partition called \"EFI "
"System Partition\" and mounted on /boot/EFI. Never delete it, because it "
"contains all your different operating systems bootloaders."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:52
msgid ""
"If the selected partition is mounted, like in the example below, you cannot "
"choose to resize, format or delete it. To be able to do that the partition "
"must be unmounted first."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:56
msgid "It is only possible to resize a partition on its right side"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:58
msgid ""
"To change a partition type (change ext3 to ext4 for example) you have to "
"delete the partition and then re-create it with the new type. The button "
"<guibutton role=\"bold\">Create</guibutton> appears when a disk empty part "
"is selected"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:63
msgid "You can choose a mount point that doesn't exist, it will be created."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:68
msgid "drakdiskMountedPartition.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:72
msgid ""
"Selecting <emphasis><guibutton>Toggle to expert mode</guibutton></emphasis> "
"gives some extra available actions, like labeling the partition, as can be "
"seen in the screenshot below."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakdisk.xml:78
msgid "drakdiskExpertUnmounted.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakedm.xml:4
msgid "Set up display manager"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakedm.xml:5
msgid "drakedm"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakedm.xml:9
msgid "drakedm.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakedm.xml:12
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakedm</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakedm.xml:12
msgid ""
"Here<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> you can choose which display "
"manager to use to log into your desktop environment. Only the ones available "
"on your system will be shown."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakedm.xml:17
msgid ""
"Most users will only notice that the provided login screens look "
"different. However, there are differences in supported features, too. LXDM "
"is a lightweight display manager, SDDM and GDM have more extras."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:3
msgid "Set up your personal firewall"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:5
msgid "drakfirewall"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:10
msgid "drakfirewall.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakfirewall</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found under the "
"Security tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled \"Set up your personal "
"firewall\". It is the same tool in the first tab of \"Configure system "
"security, permissions and audit\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:20
msgid ""
"A basic firewall is installed by default with Mageia. All the incoming "
"connections from the outside are blocked if they aren't authorised. In the "
"first screen above, you can select the services for which outside connection "
"attempts are accepted. For your security, uncheck the first box - "
"<guilabel>Everything (no firewall)</guilabel> - unless you want to disable "
"the firewall, and only check the needed services."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:27
msgid ""
"It is possible to manually enter the port numbers to open. Click on "
"<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> and a new window is opened. In the field "
"<guilabel>Other ports</guilabel>, enter the needed ports following these "
"examples :"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:32
msgid "80/tcp : open the port 80 tcp protocol"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:34
msgid "24000:24010/udp : open all the ports from 24000 to 24010 udp protocol"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:37
msgid "The listed ports should be separated by a space."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:39
msgid ""
"If the box <guilabel>Log firewall messages in system logs</guilabel> is "
"checked, the firewall messages will be saved in system logs"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:44
msgid "drakfirewall2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:49
msgid ""
"If you don't host specific services (web or mail server, file sharing, ...) "
"it is completely possible to have nothing checked at all, it is even "
"recommended, it won't prevent you from connecting to the internet."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:55
msgid ""
"The next screen deals with the Interactive Firewall options. These feature "
"allow you to be warned of connection attempts if at least the first box "
"<guilabel>Use Interactive Firewall </guilabel>is checked. Check the second "
"box to be warned if the ports are scanned (in order to find a failure "
"somewhere and enter your machine). Each box from the third one onwards "
"corresponds to a port you opened in the two first screens; in the screenshot "
"below, there are two such boxes: SSH server and 80:150/tcp. Check them to be "
"warned each time a connection is attempted on those ports."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:64
msgid "These warning are given by alert popups through the network applet."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:69
msgid "drakfirewall3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:75
msgid "drakfirewall4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:79
msgid ""
"In the last screen, choose which network interfaces are connected to the "
"Internet and must be protected. Once the OK button is clicked, the necessary "
"packages are downloaded."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><tip><para>
#: en/drakfirewall.xml:84
msgid ""
"If you don't know what to choose, have a look in MCC tab Network &amp; "
"Internet, icon Set up a new network interface."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakfont.xml:3
msgid "Manage, add and remove fonts. Import Windows(TM) fonts"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakfont.xml:6
msgid "drakfont"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakfont.xml:11
msgid "drakfont.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakfont</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is present in the Mageia "
"Control Center under the <emphasis role=\"bold\">System</emphasis> tab. It "
"allows you to manage the fonts available on the computer. The main screen "
"above shows:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:22
msgid "the installed font names, styles and sizes."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:26
msgid "a preview of the selected font."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:30
msgid "some buttons explained here later."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:36
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Get Windows Fonts: </emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:38
msgid ""
"This button automatically adds the fonts found on the Windows partition. You "
"must have Microsoft Windows installed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:41
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Options:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:43
msgid ""
"It allows you to specify the applications or devices (printers mostly)  able "
"to use the fonts."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:46
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Uninstall:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:48
msgid ""
"This button is to remove installed fonts and possibly save some place.  Be "
"careful when removing fonts because it may have serious consequences on the "
"documents that use them."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:52
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Import:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:54
msgid ""
"Allows you to add fonts from a third party (CD, internet, ...). The "
"supported formats are ttf, pfa, pfb, pcf, pfm and gsf. Click on the "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Import</emphasis> button and then on <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Add</emphasis>, a file manager pops up where you can select "
"the fonts to install, click on <emphasis role=\"bold\">Install</emphasis> "
"when done. They are installed in the folder /usr/share/fonts."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakfont.xml:60
msgid ""
"If the newly installed (or removed) fonts doesn't appear in the Drakfont "
"main screen, close and re open it to see the modifications."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakguard.xml:3
msgid "Parental Controls"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakguard.xml:5
msgid "drakguard"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakguard.xml:10
msgid "drakguard.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakguard</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found in the Mageia "
"Control Center, under the Security tab, labelled <guilabel>Parental "
"Control</guilabel>. If you don't see this label, you have to install the "
"drakguard package (not installed by default)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakguard.xml:21 en/msecgui.xml:19
msgid "Presentation"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:23
msgid ""
"Drakguard is an easy way to set up parental controls on your computer to "
"restrict who can do what, and at which times of day. Drakguard has three "
"useful capabilities:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:29
msgid ""
"It restricts web access to named users to set times of day. It does this by "
"controlling the shorewall firewall built into Mageia."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:35
msgid ""
"It blocks execution of particular commands by named users so these users can "
"only execute what you accept them to execute."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:40
msgid ""
"It restricts access to websites, both manually defined through "
"blacklists/whitelists, but also dynamically based on the content of the "
"website. To achieve this Drakguard uses the leading opensource parental "
"control blocker DansGuardian."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakguard.xml:49
msgid "Configuring Parental controls"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><warning><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:52
msgid ""
"If your computer contains hard drive partitions that are formatted in Ext2, "
"Ext3, or ReiserFS format you will see a pop up offering to configure ACL on "
"your partitions. ACL stands for Access Control Lists, and is a Linux kernel "
"feature that allows access to individual files to be restricted to named "
"users. ACL is built into Ext4 and Btrfs file systems, but must be enabled by "
"an option in Ext2, Ext3, or Reiserfs partitions. If you select 'Yes' to this "
"prompt drakguard will configure all your partitions to support ACL, and will "
"then suggest you reboot."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:61
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Enable parental control</guibutton>: If checked, the parental "
"control is enabled and the access to <guilabel>Block programs</guilabel> tab "
"is opened."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:65
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Block all network traffic</guibutton>: If checked, all the "
"websites are blocked, except the ones in the whitelist tab. Otherwise, all "
"the websites are allowed, except the ones in the blacklist tab."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:69
msgid ""
"<guibutton>User access</guibutton>: Users on the left hand side will have "
"their access restricted according to the rules you define. Users on the "
"right hand side have unrestricted access so adult users of the computer are "
"not inconvenienced. Select a user in the left hand side and click on "
"<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to add him/her as an allowed user.  Select an "
"user in the right hand side and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to "
"remove him/her from the allowed users."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:77
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Time control:</guibutton> If checked, internet access is allowed "
"with restrictions between the <guilabel>Start</guilabel> time and "
"<guilabel>End</guilabel> time. It is totally blocked outside these time "
"window."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/drakguard.xml:83
msgid "Blacklist/Whitelist tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:85
msgid ""
"Enter the website URL in the first field at the top and click on the "
"<guibutton>Add</guibutton> button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/drakguard.xml:90
msgid "Block Programs Tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:92
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Block Defined Applications</guibutton>: Enables the use of ACL to "
"restrict access to specific applications. Insert the path to the "
"applications you wish to block."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/drakguard.xml:96
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Unblock Users list</guibutton>: Users listed on the right hand "
"side will not be subject to acl blocking."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakgw.xml:9
msgid "Share the Internet connection with other local machines"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakgw.xml:12
msgid "drakgw"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakgw.xml:17
msgid "drakgw.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakgw.xml:25
msgid "Principles"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakgw.xml:29
msgid "../drakgw-net.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:27
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>This is useful when you have a "
"computer (3) which has Internet (2) access and is connected also to a local "
"network (1). You can use computer (3) as a gateway to give that access to "
"other workstations (5) and (6) in the local network (1). For this, the "
"gateway must have two interfaces; the first one such as an ethernet card "
"must be connected to the local network, and the second one (4) connected to "
"the Internet (2)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:39
msgid ""
"The first step is to verify that the network and the access to Internet are "
"set up, as documented in <xref linkend=\"draknetcenter\"/>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakgw.xml:45
msgid "Gateway wizard"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:48
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakgw</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:47
msgid ""
"The wizard<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> offers successive steps "
"which are shown below:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:54
msgid ""
"If the wizard does not detect at least two interfaces, it warns about this "
"and asks to stop the network and configure the hardware."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:60
msgid ""
"specify the interface used for the Internet connection. The wizard "
"automatically suggests one of the interfaces, but you should verify that "
"what is proposed is correct."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:66
msgid ""
"specify which interface is used for the Lan access. The wizard also proposes "
"one, check that this is correct."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:71
msgid ""
"The wizard proposes parameters for the Lan network, such as IP address, mask "
"and domain name. Check that these parameters are compatible with the actual "
"configuration. It is recommended that you accept these values."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:78
msgid ""
"specify if the computer has to be used as a DNS server. If yes, the wizard "
"will check that <code>bind</code> is installed.  Otherwise, you have to "
"specify the address of a DNS server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:84
msgid ""
"specify if the computer is to be used as a DHCP server. If yes, the wizard "
"will check that <code>dhcp-server</code> is installed and offer to configure "
"it, with start and end addresses in the DHCP range."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:91
msgid ""
"specify if the computer is to be used as a proxy server. If yes, the wizard "
"will check that <code>squid</code> is installed and offer to configure it, "
"with the address of the administrator (admin@mydomain.com), name of the "
"proxy (myfirewall@mydomaincom), the port (3128) and the cache size (100 Mb)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:99
msgid ""
"The last step allows you to check if the gateway machine is connected to "
"printers and to share them."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:104
msgid "You will be warned about the need to check the firewall if it is active."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakgw.xml:109
msgid "Configure the client"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:111
msgid ""
"If you have configured the gateway machine with DHCP, you only need to "
"specify in the network configuration tool that you get an address "
"automatically (using DHCP). The parameters will be obtained when connecting "
"to the network. This method is valid whatever operating system the client is "
"using."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:117
msgid ""
"If you must manually specify the network parameters, you must in particular "
"specify the gateway by entering the IP-address of the machine acting as the "
"gateway."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakgw.xml:123
msgid "Stop connection sharing"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakgw.xml:125
msgid ""
"If you want to stop sharing the connection on the Mageia computer, launch "
"the tool. It will offer to reconfigure the connection or to stop the "
"sharing."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:3
msgid "Hosts definitions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:5
msgid "drakhosts"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:10
msgid "drakhosts.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakhosts</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:14
msgid ""
"If some systems on your network grant you services, and have fixed "
"IP-addresses, this tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows to "
"specify a name to access them more easily. Then you can use that name "
"instead of the IP-address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:20
msgid "<guibutton>Add</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:22
msgid ""
"With this button, you add the name for a new system. You will get a window "
"to specify the IP-address, the host name for the system, and optionally an "
"alias which can be used in the same way that the name is."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:27
msgid "<guibutton>Modify</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakhosts.xml:29
msgid ""
"You can access the parameters of an entry previously defined. You get the "
"same window."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakinvictus.xml:3
msgid "Advanced setup for network interfaces and firewall"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakinvictus.xml:3
msgid "drakinvictus"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakinvictus.xml:8
msgid "drakinvictus.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakinvictus.xml:12 en/draknetcenter.xml:187 en/draknetprofile.xml:12 en/drakups.xml:12 en/drakwizard_bind.xml:12 en/drakxservices.xml:12
msgid ""
"This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you "
"can write this help, please contact <link "
"ns2:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team\"> the Doc "
"team.</link> Thanking you in advance."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakinvictus.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakinvictus</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:10
msgid "Network Center"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:12
msgid "draknetcenter"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:17
msgid "draknetcenter.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:22
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draknetcenter</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:21
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found under the "
"Network &amp; Internet tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled \"Network "
"Center\""
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:31
msgid ""
"When this tool is launched, a window opens listing all the networks "
"configured on the computer, whatever their type (wired, wireless, satellite, "
"etc.). When clicking on one of them, three or four buttons appear, depending "
"on the network type, to allow you to look after the network, change its "
"settings or connect/disconnect. This tool isn't intended to create a "
"network, for this see <guilabel>Set up a new network interface (LAN, ISDN, "
"ADSL, ...)</guilabel> in the same MCC tab."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:43
msgid "../draknetcenterEthernet-on.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:47
msgid "../draknetcenterEthernet-off.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:52
msgid "../draknetcenterWireless-off.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:56
msgid "../draknetcenterWireless-on.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:39
msgid ""
"In the screenshot below, given as example, we can see two networks, the "
"first one is wired and connected, recognizable by this icon <placeholder "
"type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"0\"/> (this one is not connected<placeholder "
"type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"1\"/> ) and the second section shows "
"wireless networks, not connected recognizable by this icon <placeholder "
"type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"2\"/> and this one <placeholder "
"type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"3\"/>if connected. For the other network "
"types, the colour code is always the same, green if connected and red if not "
"connected."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:62
msgid ""
"In the wireless part of the screen, you can also see all the detected "
"networks, with the <guilabel>SSID</guilabel>, the <guilabel>Signal "
"strengh</guilabel>, if they are encrypted (in red) or not (in green), and "
"the <guilabel>Operating mode</guilabel>. Click on the chosen one and then "
"either on <guibutton>Monitor</guibutton>, <guibutton>Configure</guibutton> "
"or <guibutton>Connect</guibutton>. It is possible here to go from a network "
"to another one. If a private network is selected, the Network Settings "
"window (see below) will open and ask you for extra settings ( an encryption "
"key in particular)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:72
msgid "Click on <guibutton>Refresh</guibutton> to update the screen."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:76
msgid "draknetcenter1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:84
msgid "The Monitor button"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:88
msgid "draknetcenter4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:92
msgid ""
"This button allows you to watch the network activity, downloads (toward the "
"PC, in red) and uploads (toward the Internet, in green). The same screen is "
"available by right clicking on the <guimenu>Internet icon in the system tray "
"-> Monitor Network</guimenu>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:97
msgid ""
"There is a tab for each network (here eth0 is the wired network, lo the "
"local loopback and wlan0 the wireless network) and a tab connection which "
"gives details about connection status."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><note><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:102
msgid ""
"At the bottom of the window is a title <guilabel>Traffic "
"accounting</guilabel>, we will look at that in the next section."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:108
msgid "The Configure button"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:110
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">A - For a wired network</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:114
msgid "draknetcenter2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:118
msgid ""
"It is possible to change all the settings given during network "
"creation. Most of the time, checking <guibutton>Automatic IP</guibutton> "
"<guibutton>(BOOTP/DHCP)</guibutton> will do, but in case of problems, manual "
"configuration may give better results."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:123
msgid ""
"For a residential network, the <guilabel>IP address</guilabel> always looks "
"like 192.168.0.x, <guilabel>Netmask</guilabel> is 255.255.255.0, and the "
"<guilabel>Gateway</guilabel> and <guilabel>DNS servers</guilabel> are "
"available from your providers website."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:128
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Enable traffic accounting</guibutton> if checked this will count "
"the traffic on a hourly, daily or monthly basis. The results are visible in "
"the Network monitor detailed in the previous section. Once enabled, you may "
"have to reconnect to the network."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:133
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Allow interface to be controlled by Network "
"Manager:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:140 en/draknetcenter.xml:185
msgid "<guibutton>The button Advanced:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:148
msgid "draknetcenter5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:152
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">B - For a wireless network</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:154
msgid "Only the items not already seen above are explained."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:158
msgid "draknetcenter3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:162
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Operating mode:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:164
msgid ""
"Select <guilabel>Managed</guilabel> if the connection is via an access "
"point, there is an <emphasis role=\"bold\">ESSID</emphasis> detected.  "
"Select <guilabel>Ad-hoc</guilabel> if it is a peer to peer network. Select "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Master</emphasis> if your network card is used as "
"the access point, your network card needs to support this mode."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:170
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Encryption mode and Encryption key:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:173
msgid "If it is a private network, you need to know these settings."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:175
msgid ""
"<guilabel>WEP</guilabel> uses a password and is weaker than WPA which uses a "
"passphrase. <guilabel>WPA Pre-Shared Key</guilabel> is also called WPA "
"personal or WPA home. <guilabel>WPA Enterprise</guilabel> is not often used "
"in private networks."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:180
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Allow access point roaming</emphasis>:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:182
msgid ""
"Roaming is a technology which enables allows computer to change its access "
"point while remaining connected to the network."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:193
msgid "draknetcenter6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:201
msgid "The Advanced Settings button"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetcenter.xml:209
msgid "draknetcenter7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draknetprofile.xml:3
msgid "Manage different network profiles"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draknetprofile.xml:3
msgid "draknetprofile"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknetprofile.xml:8
msgid "draknetprofile.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draknetprofile.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draknetprofile</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:9
msgid "Share drives and directories using NFS"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draknfs.xml:11
msgid "draknfs"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknfs.xml:16
msgid "draknfs.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:24
msgid "Prerequisites"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:27
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draknfs</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:26
msgid ""
"When the wizard<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is launched for the "
"first time, it may display the following message:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><blockquote><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:33
msgid "The package nfs-utils needs to be installed. Do you want to install it?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:37
msgid "After completing the installation, a window with an empty list is displayed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:42
msgid "Main window"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:44
msgid ""
"A list of directories which are shared is displayed. At this step, the list "
"is empty. The <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button gives access to a "
"configuration tool."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:50
msgid "Modify entry"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:52
msgid ""
"The configuration tool is labeled \"Modify entry\". It may be also launched "
"with the <guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. The following parameters are "
"available."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknfs.xml:58
msgid "draknfs4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:64
msgid "NFS Directory"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:66
msgid ""
"Here you can specify which directory is to be shared. The "
"<guibutton>Directory</guibutton> button gives access to a browser to choose "
"it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:72
msgid "Host access"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:74
msgid ""
"Here you can specify the hosts that are authorized to access the shared "
"directory."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:77
msgid "NFS clients may be specified in a number of ways:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:79
msgid ""
"<emphasis>single host</emphasis>: a host either by an abbreviated name "
"recognized be the resolver, fully qualified domain name, or an IP address"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:83
msgid "<emphasis>netgroups</emphasis>: NIS netgroups may be given as @group."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:86
msgid ""
"<emphasis>wildcards</emphasis>: machine names may contain the wildcard "
"characters * and ?. For instance: *.cs.foo.edu matches all hosts in the "
"domain cs.foo.edu."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:90
msgid ""
"<emphasis>IP networks</emphasis>: you can also export directories to all "
"hosts on an IP (sub-)network simultaneously. For example, either "
"`/255.255.252.0' or `/22' appended to the network base address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:96
msgid "User ID Mapping"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:98
msgid ""
"<emphasis>map root user as anonymous</emphasis>: maps requests from uid/gid "
"0 to the anonymous uid/gid (root_squash). The root user from the client "
"cannot read or write to the files on the server which are created by root on "
"the server itself."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:103
msgid ""
"<emphasis>allow real remote root access</emphasis>: turn off root "
"squashing. This option is mainly useful for diskless clients "
"(no_root_squash)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:107
msgid ""
"<emphasis>map all users to anonymous user</emphasis>: maps all uids and gids "
"to the anonymous user (all_squash). Useful for NFS-exported public FTP "
"directories, news spool directories, etc. The opposite option is no user UID "
"mapping (no_all_squash), which is the default setting."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:113
msgid ""
"<emphasis>anonuid and anongid</emphasis>: explicitly set the uid and gid of "
"the anonymous account."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:118
msgid "Advanced options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:120
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Secured Connection</emphasis>: this option requires that requests "
"originate on an internet port less than IPPORT_RESERVED (1024).  This option "
"is on by default."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:124
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Read-Only share</emphasis>: allow either only read or both read "
"and write requests on this NFS volume. The default is to disallow any "
"request which changes the filesystem. This can also be made explicit by "
"using this option."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:129
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Synchronous access</emphasis>: prevents the NFS server from "
"violating the NFS protocol and to reply to requests before any changes made "
"by these requests have been committed to stable storage (e.g. disc drive)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:134
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Subtree checking</emphasis>: enable subtree checking which can "
"help improve security in some cases, but can decrease reliability. See "
"exports(5) man page for more details."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:141 en/draksambashare.xml:201
msgid "Menu entries"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:143
msgid "So far the list has at least one entry."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draknfs.xml:147
msgid "draknfs5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:153 en/draksambashare.xml:207
msgid "File|Write conf"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:155
msgid "Save the current configuration."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:159
msgid "NFS Server|Restart"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:161 en/draksambashare.xml:222
msgid "The server is stopped and restarted with the current configuration files."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/draknfs.xml:166
msgid "NFS Server|Reload"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><para>
#: en/draknfs.xml:168 en/draksambashare.xml:229
msgid ""
"The configuration displayed is reloaded from the current configuration "
"files."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:10
msgid "Proxy"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:12
msgid "drakproxy"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:17
msgid "drakproxy.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:24
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakproxy</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:22
msgid ""
"If you have to use a proxy server to access to the internet, you can use "
"this tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> to configure it. Your net "
"administrator will give you the information you need. You can also specify "
"some services which can be accessed without the proxy by exception."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakproxy.xml:30
msgid ""
"From Wikipedia, on 2012-09-24, article Proxy server: In computer networks, a "
"proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application)  that acts as "
"an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other "
"servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service, "
"such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a "
"different server. The proxy server evaluates the request as a way to "
"simplify and control their complexity."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:3
msgid "Configure Media"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:5
msgid "drakrpm-edit-media"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:17
msgid "drakrpm-edit-media.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><important><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:22
msgid ""
"First thing to do after an install is to add software sources (also known as "
"repositories, media, mirrors). That means you must select the media sources "
"to be used to install and update packages and applications. (see Add button "
"below)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:27
msgid ""
"If you install (or upgrade) Mageia using an optical media (DVD or CD) or a "
"USB device, there will be a software source configured to the optical media "
"used. To avoid being asked to insert the media when you install new "
"packages, you should disable (or delete) this media.  (It will have the "
"media type CD-Rom)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:33
msgid ""
"Your system is running under an architecture which may be 32-bit (called "
"i586), or 64-bit (called x86_64). Some packages are independent of whether "
"your system is 32-bit or 64-bit; these are called noarch packages. They "
"don't have their own noarch directories on the mirrors, but are all in both "
"the i586 and the x86_64 media."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:42
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakrpm-edit-media</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:40
msgid ""
"This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Software management.</emphasis><placeholder type=\"footnote\" "
"id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:46
msgid "The columns"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><bridgehead>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:48
msgid "Column Enable:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:50
msgid ""
"The checked media will be used to install new packages. Be cautious with "
"some media such as Testing and Debug, they could make your system unusable."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><bridgehead>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:54
msgid "Column Update:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:56
msgid ""
"The checked media will be used to update packages, it must be enabled. Only "
"media with \"Update\" in its name should be selected. For security reasons, "
"this column isn't modifiable in this tool, you must open a console as root "
"and type <emphasis role=\"bold\">drakrpm-edit-media --expert.</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><bridgehead>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:62
msgid "Column medium:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:64
msgid ""
"Display the medium name. Mageia official repositories for final release "
"versions contain at least:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:69
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Core</emphasis> which contains most programs "
"available supported by Mageia."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:74
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Nonfree</emphasis> which contains some programs "
"which are not free"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:79
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Tainted</emphasis> free software for which there "
"might be patent claims in some countries."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:82
msgid "Each medium has 4 sub-sections:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:86
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Release</emphasis> the packages as of the day the "
"this version of Mageia was released."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:91
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Updates</emphasis> the packages updated since "
"release due to security or bug concerns. Everyone should have this medium "
"enabled, even with a very slow internet connection."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:97
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Backports</emphasis> some packages of new versions "
"backported from Cauldron (the next version under development)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:103
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Testing</emphasis> which is used for temporary tests "
"of new updates, to allow the bug reporters and the QA team to validate the "
"corrections."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:111
msgid "The buttons on the right"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:114
msgid "<guibutton>Remove:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:116
msgid ""
"To remove a medium, click on it and then on this button. It is wise to "
"remove the medium used for the installation (CD or DVD for example)  since "
"all the packages it contains are in the official Core release medium."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:121
msgid "<guibutton>Edit:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:123
msgid ""
"Allows you to modify the selected medium settings, (URL, downloader and "
"proxy)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:126
msgid "<guibutton>Add:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:128
msgid ""
"Add the official repositories available on the Internet. These repositories "
"contain only safe and well tested software. Clicking on the \"Add\" button "
"adds the mirrorlist to your configuration, it is designed to make sure that "
"you install and update from a mirror close to you. If you prefer to choose a "
"specific mirror, then add it by choosing \"Add a specific media mirror\" "
"from the drop-down \"File\" menu."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:135
msgid "<guibutton>Up and down arrows:</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:137
msgid ""
"Change the list order. When Drakrpm looks for a package, it reads the list "
"in the displayed order and will install the first package found for the same "
"release number - in the event of a version mismatch, the latest release will "
"be installed. So if possible, put the fastest repositories at the top."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:145 en/harddrake2.xml:64
msgid "The menu"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:147
msgid "<guimenu>File -> Update:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:149
msgid ""
"A window pops up with the media list. Select the ones you want to update and "
"click on the <guibutton>Update</guibutton> button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:152
msgid "<guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:154
msgid ""
"Suppose you aren't happy with the actual mirror, because for example it's "
"too slow or often unavailable, you can choose another mirror. Select all the "
"actual media and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to take them "
"out. Click on <guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror</guimenu>, choose "
"between update only or the full set (if you do not know, choose the "
"<guibutton>Full set of sources</guibutton>) and accept the contact by "
"clicking on <guibutton>Yes</guibutton>. This window opens:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:165
msgid "drakrpmEditMedia2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:169
msgid ""
"You can see, on the left, a list of countries, choose yours or one very "
"close by clicking on the > symbol, this will display all the available "
"mirrors in that country. Select one and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:174
msgid "<guimenu>File -> Add a custom medium:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:176
msgid ""
"It is possible to install a new media (from a third party for example) that "
"isn't supported by Mageia. A new window appears:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:181
msgid "rpmdrakeEditMedia1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:179
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>Select the medium type, find a "
"smart name that well define the medium and give the URL (or the path, "
"according to the medium type)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:187
msgid "<guimenu>Options -> Global options:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:189
msgid ""
"This item allows you to choose when to \"Verify RPMs to be installed\" "
"(always or never), the download program (curl, wget or aria2) and to define "
"the download policy for information about the packages (on demand -by "
"default-, update only, always or never)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:194
msgid "<guimenu>Options -> Manage keys:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:196
msgid ""
"To guarantee a high level of security, digital keys are used to authenticate "
"the media. It is possible for each medium to allow or disallow a key. In the "
"window that appear, select a medium and then click on "
"<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to allow a new key or to select a key and click "
"on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to disallow that key."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><warning><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:203
msgid "Do this with care, as with all security-related questions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:204
msgid "<guimenu>Options -> Proxy:</guimenu>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:206
msgid ""
"If you need to use a proxy server for internet access, you can configure it "
"here. You only need to give the <guibutton>Proxy hostname</guibutton> and if "
"necessary a <guilabel>Username</guilabel> and <guilabel>Password</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakrpm-edit-media.xml:213
msgid ""
"For more information about configuring the media, see <link "
"ns2:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Software_management\">the Mageia Wiki "
"page</link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:10
msgid "Share directories and drives with Samba"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:13
msgid "draksambashare"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:18
msgid "draksambashare.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:29
msgid ""
"Samba is a protocol used in different Operating Systems to share some "
"resources like directories or printers. This tool allows you to configure "
"the machine as a Samba server using the protocol SMB/CIFS. This protocol is "
"also used by Windows(R) and workstations with this OS can access the "
"resources of the Samba server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:37
msgid "Preparation"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:39
msgid ""
"To be accessed from other workstations, the server has to have a fixed IP "
"address. This can be specified directly on the server, for example with "
"<xref linkend=\"draknetcenter-ti1\"/>, or at the DHCP server which "
"identifies the station with its MAC-address and give it always the same "
"address. The firewall has also to allow the incoming requests to the Samba "
"server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:50
msgid "Wizard - Standalone server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:53
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing<emphasis "
"role=\"bold\"> draksambashare</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:52
msgid ""
"At the first run, the tools <placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> checks "
"if needed packages are installed and proposes to install them if they are "
"not yet present. Then the wizard to configure the Samba server is launched."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:61
msgid "draksambashare0.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:67
msgid ""
"In the next window the Standalone server configuration option is already "
"selected."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:71
msgid "draksambashare1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:77
msgid ""
"Then specify the name of the workgroup. This name should be the same for the "
"access to the shared resources."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:80
msgid ""
"The netbios name is the name which will be used to designate the server on "
"the network."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:85
msgid "draksambashare2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:91
msgid "Choose the security mode:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:95
msgid ""
"<guilabel>user</guilabel>: the client must be authorized to access the "
"resource"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:100
msgid ""
"<guilabel>share</guilabel>: the client authenticates itself separately for "
"each share"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:105
msgid ""
"You can specify which hosts are allowed to access the resources, with IP "
"address or host name."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:110
msgid "draksambashare3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:115
msgid ""
"Specify the server banner. The banner is the way this server will be "
"described in the Windows workstations."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:120
msgid "draksambashare4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:126
msgid "The place where Samba can log information can be specified at the next step."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:131
msgid "draksambashare5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:137
msgid ""
"The wizard displays a list of the chosen parameters before you accept the "
"configuration. When accepted, the configuration will be written in "
"<code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:143
msgid "draksambashare6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:151
msgid "Wizard - Primary domain controller"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:155
msgid "draksambashare13.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:153
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>If the \"Primary domain "
"controller\" option is selected, the wizard asks for indication if Wins is "
"to support or not and to provide admin users names. The following steps are "
"then the same as for standalone server, except you can choose also the "
"security mode:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:164
msgid ""
"<guilabel>domain</guilabel>: provides a mechanism for storing all user and "
"group accounts in a central, shared, account repository.  The centralized "
"account repository is shared between (security)  controllers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:173
msgid "Declare a directory to share"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:175
msgid "With the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button, we get:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:179
msgid "draksambashare15.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:184
msgid ""
"A new entry is thus added. It can be modified with the "
"<guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. Options can be edited, such as whether "
"the directory is visible to the public, writable or browseable.  The share "
"name can not be modified."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:191
msgid "draksambashare16.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:203
msgid "When the list has at least one entry, menu entries can be used."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:209
msgid "Save the current configuration in <code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:214
msgid "Samba server|Configure"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:216
msgid "The wizard can be run again with this command."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:220
msgid "Samba server|Restart"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><formalpara><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:227
msgid "Samba Server|Reload"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:235
msgid "Printers share"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:237
msgid "Samba also allows you to share printers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:241
msgid "draksambashare17.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><screenshot>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:239 en/drakvpn.xml:46 en/logdrake.xml:89 en/rpmdrake.xml:58 en/rpmdrake.xml:163 en/rpmdrake.xml:173 en/rpmdrake.xml:183 en/rpmdrake.xml:193 en/rpmdrake.xml:203 en/rpmdrake.xml:238
msgid "<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:247
msgid "Samba users"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:253
msgid "draksambashare18.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/draksambashare.xml:249
msgid ""
"In this tab, you can add users who are allowed to access the shared "
"resources when authentication is required. You can add users from <xref "
"linkend=\"userdrake-ti1\"/><placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draksec.xml:3
msgid "Configure authentication for Mageia tools"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draksec.xml:6
msgid "draksec"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksec.xml:11
msgid "draksec0.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draksec</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/>is present in the Mageia "
"Control Center under the tab <emphasis role=\"bold\">Security</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:19
msgid ""
"It allows to give the regular users the needed rights to accomplish tasks "
"usually done by the administrator."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:22
msgid "Click on the little arrow before the item you want to drop down:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksec.xml:27
msgid "draksec.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:31
msgid ""
"Most of the tools available in the Mageia Control Center are displayed in "
"the left side of the window (see the screenshot above) and for each tool, a "
"drop down list on the right side gives the choice between:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:37
msgid ""
"Default: The launch mode depends on the chosen security level. See in the "
"same MCC tab, the tool \"Configure system security, permissions and audit\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:43
msgid "User password: The user password is asked before the tool launching."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:48
msgid "Administrator password: The root password is asked before the tool launching"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/draksec.xml:53
msgid "No password: The tool is launched without asking any password."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:11
msgid "Snapshots"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:12
msgid "draksnapshot-config"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:18
msgid "draksnapshot-config.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:22
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draksnapshot-config </emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:22
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is available in MCC's "
"<guilabel>System</guilabel> tab, in the <guilabel>Administration "
"tools</guilabel> section."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:26
msgid ""
"When you start this tool in MCC for the first time, you will see a message "
"about installing draksnapshot. Click on <guibutton>Install</guibutton> to "
"proceed. Draksnapshot and some other packages it needs will be installed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:31
msgid ""
"Click again on <guilabel>Snapshots</guilabel>, you will see the "
"<guilabel>Settings</guilabel> screen. Tick <guilabel>Enable "
"Backups</guilabel> and, if you want to backup the whole system, "
"<guilabel>Backup the whole system</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:34
msgid ""
"If you only want to backup part of your directories, then choose "
"<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>. You will see a little pop-up screen. Use the "
"<guibutton>Add</guibutton> and <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> buttons next to "
"the <guilabel>Backup list</guilabel> to include or exclude directories and "
"files from the backup. Use the same buttons next to the "
"<guilabel>Exclude</guilabel> list to remove subdirectories and/or files from "
"the chosen directories, that should <emphasis role=\"bold\">not</emphasis> "
"be included in the backup. Click on <guibutton>Close</guibutton> when you "
"are done."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:41
msgid ""
"Now give the path to <guilabel>Where to backup</guilabel>, or choose the "
"<guibutton>Browse</guibutton> button to select the correct path. Any mounted "
"USB-key or external HD can be found in <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">/run/media/your_user_name/</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksnapshot-config.xml:45
msgid "Click on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton> to make the snapshot."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/draksound.xml:3
msgid "Sound Configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/draksound.xml:4
msgid "draksound"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksound.xml:8
msgid "draksound.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:11
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">draksound</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:11 en/mousedrake.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is present in the Mageia "
"Control Center under the tab <emphasis role=\"bold\">Hardware</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:13
msgid ""
"Draksound deals with the sound configuration, PulseAudio options and "
"troubleshooting. It will help you if you experience sound problems or if you "
"change the sound card."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:16
msgid ""
"<guilabel>PulseAudio</guilabel> is a sound server. It receives all the sound "
"inputs, mixes them according to the user preferences and sends the resulting "
"sound to the output. See <guimenu>Menu ->Sound and video -> PulseAudio "
"volume control</guimenu> to set these preferences."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:20
msgid ""
"PulseAudio is the default sound server and it is recommended to leave it "
"enabled."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:22
msgid ""
"<guilabel>Glitch-Free</guilabel> improves PulseAudio with some programs. It "
"is also recommended to leave it enabled."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:24
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Troubleshooting</guibutton> button gives assistance with "
"fixing any problems you may have. You will find it helpful to try this "
"before asking the community for help."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/draksound.xml:27
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button displays a new window with an "
"obvious button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/draksound.xml:30
msgid "draksound1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakups.xml:3
msgid "Set up a UPS for power monitoring"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakups.xml:3
msgid "drakups"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakups.xml:8
msgid "drakups.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakups.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakups</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:3
msgid "Configure VPN Connection to secure network access"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:6
msgid "drakvpn"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:11
msgid "drakvpn1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:19
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakvpn</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:18
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows to configure "
"secure access to a remote network establishing a tunnel between the local "
"workstation and the remote network. We discuss here only of the "
"configuration on the workstation side. We assume that the remote network is "
"already in operation, and that you have the connection information from the "
"network administrator, like a .pcf configuration file ."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:30
msgid "Configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:32
msgid ""
"First, select either Cisco VPN Concentrator or OpenVPN, depending on which "
"protocol is used for your virtual private network."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:35
msgid "Then give your connection a name."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:37
msgid "At the next screen, provide the details for your VPN connection."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:42
msgid "For Cisco VPN"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:48
msgid "drakvpn3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:54
msgid ""
"For openvpn. The openvpn package and its dependencies will be installed the "
"first time the tool is used."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:59
msgid "drakvpn7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:57
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>Select the files that you "
"received from the network administrator."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:64
msgid "Advanced parameters:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:68
msgid "drakvpn8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:72
msgid "The next screen asks for IP-address of the gateway."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:76
msgid ""
"When the parameters are set, you have the option of starting the VPN "
"connection."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakvpn.xml:79
msgid ""
"This VPN connection can be set to start automatically with a network "
"connection. To do this, reconfigure the network connection to always connect "
"to this VPN."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:3
msgid "Configure webserver"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:3
msgid "drakwizard apache2"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:8
msgid "drakwizard_apache2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:12
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard apache2</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:12
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can help you to set up a "
"web server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:15
msgid "What is a web server?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:17
msgid ""
"Web server is the software that helps to deliver web content that can be "
"accessed through the Internet. (From Wikipedia)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:21
msgid "Setting up a web server with drakwizard apache2"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:23
msgid "Welcome to the web server wizard."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:30
msgid "drakwizard-web-step1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:34 en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:49 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:34 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:55
msgid "The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:38 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:38
msgid "Selecting Server Exposer: Local Net and/or World"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:41
msgid "drakwizard-web-step2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:45
msgid ""
"Exposing the web server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad "
"things."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:49
msgid "Server User Module"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:52
msgid "drakwizard-web-step3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:56
msgid "Allows users to create their own sites."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:60
msgid "User web directory name"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:63
msgid "drakwizard-web-step4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:67
msgid ""
"The user needs to create and populate this directory, then the server will "
"display it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:71
msgid "Server Document Root"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:74
msgid "drakwizard-web-step5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:78
msgid "Allows you to configure the path to the web servers default documents."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:82 en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:83 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:71 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:144 en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:105
msgid "Summary"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:85
msgid "drakwizard-web-step6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:89 en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:91 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:78 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:153 en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:112
msgid ""
"Take a second to check these options, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:93 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:82 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:173 en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:116
msgid "Finish"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:96
msgid "drakwizard-web-step7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_apache2.xml:100 en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:89 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:183 en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:123
msgid "You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_bind.xml:3
msgid "Configure DNS"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_bind.xml:3
msgid "drakwizard bind"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_bind.xml:8
msgid "drakwizard_bind.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_bind.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard bind</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:3
msgid "Configure DHCP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:5
msgid "drakwizard dhcp"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:10
msgid "drakwizard_dhcp.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:15
msgid ""
"This tool is broken in Mageia 4 because of new naming scheme for the Net "
"interfaces"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:20
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard dhcp</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:19
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can help you to set up a "
"<acronym>DHCP</acronym> server. It is a component of drakwizard which should "
"be installed before you can access to it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:26
msgid "What is DHCP?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:28
msgid ""
"The Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (<acronym>DHCP</acronym>) is a "
"standardized networking protocol used on IP networks that dynamically "
"configures IP addresses and other information that is needed for Internet "
"communication. (From Wikipedia)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:35
msgid "Setting up a DHCP server with drakwizard dhcp"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:37
msgid "Welcome to the DHCP server wizard."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:45
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:54
msgid "Selecting Adaptor"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:58
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:62
msgid ""
"Choose the network interface, which is connected to the subnet, and for "
"which DHCP will assign IP addresses, and then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:68
msgid "Select IP range"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:72
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:76
msgid ""
"Select the beginning and ending IP addresses of the range of IPs you want "
"the server to offer, along with the IP of the gateway machine connecting to "
"some place outside the local network, hopefully close to the Internet, then "
"click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:87
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:96
msgid "Hold on..."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:100
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:104
msgid ""
"This can be fixed. Click <guibutton>Previous</guibutton> a few times and "
"change things around."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:109
msgid "Hours later..."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:113
msgid "drakwizard-dhcp-step6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:121 en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:87 en/drakwizard_squid.xml:189
msgid "What is done"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:125
msgid "Installing the package dhcp-server if needed;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:129
msgid "Saving <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf</code> in <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf.orig;</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:134
msgid ""
"Creating a new <code>dhcpd.conf</code> starting from "
"<code>/usr/share/wizards/dhcp_wizard/scripts/dhcpd.conf.default</code> and "
"adding the new parameters:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:140
msgid "<code>hname</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:144
msgid "<code>dns</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:148
msgid "net"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:152
msgid "ip"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:156
msgid "<code>mask</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:160
msgid "<code>rng1</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:164
msgid "<code>rng2</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:168
msgid "<code>dname</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:172
msgid "<code>gateway</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:176
msgid "<code>tftpserverip</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:180
msgid "<code>dhcpd_interface</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:186
msgid ""
"Also modifying Webmin configuration file "
"<code>/etc/webmin/dhcpd/config</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_dhcp.xml:191
msgid "Restarting <code>dhcpd.</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:10
msgid "Configure time"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:12
msgid "drakwizard ntp"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:19
msgid "drakwizard_ntp.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:25
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard ntp</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:24
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> purpose is to set the "
"time of your server synchronised with an external server. It isn't installed "
"by default and you have to also install the drakwizard and drakwizard-base "
"packages."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:32
msgid "Setup a NTP server with drakwizard ntp"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:36
msgid ""
"After a welcome screen (see above), the second one ask you to choose three "
"time servers in the drop down lists and suggests to use pool.ntp.org twice "
"because this server always points to available time servers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:43
msgid "drakwizard-ntp1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:49
msgid "drakwizard-ntp2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata><info>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:51
msgid "<author> <personname/> </author> <pubdate/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:50
msgid "<placeholder type=\"info\" id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:63
msgid ""
"The following screens allows to choose the region and the city and then, you "
"arrive on a summary. If something is wrong, you can obviously change it "
"using the <guibutton>Previous</guibutton>button.  If everything is right, "
"click on the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button to proceed to the test. It "
"may take a while and you finally get this screen below:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:72
msgid "drakwizard-ntp3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:78
msgid "Click on the <guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button to close the tool"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:89
msgid "This tool executes the following steps:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:93
msgid "Installing the package <code>ntp</code> if needed"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:97
msgid ""
"Saving the files <code>/etc/sysconfig/clock</code> to "
"<code>/etc/sysconfig/clock.orig</code> and "
"<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> to "
"<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers.orig</code>;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:104
msgid ""
"Writing a new file <code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> with the list of "
"servers;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:109
msgid ""
"Modifying the file <code>/etc/ntp.conf</code> by inserting the first server "
"name;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:114
msgid ""
"Stopping and starting <code>crond</code>, <code>atd</code> and "
"<code>ntpd</code> services;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_ntp.xml:119
msgid "Setting the hardware clock to the current system time with UTC reference."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:3
msgid "Configure FTP"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:3
msgid "drakwizard proftpd"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:8
msgid "drakwizard_proftpd.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:12
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard proftpd</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:12
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can help you to set up an "
"<acronym>FTP</acronym> server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:15
msgid "What is <acronym>FTP</acronym>?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:17
msgid ""
"File Transfer Protocol (<acronym>FTP</acronym>) is a standard network "
"protocol used to transfer files from one host to another host over a "
"<acronym>TCP</acronym>-based network, such as the Internet. (From Wikipedia)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:21
msgid "Setting up an FTP server with drakwizard proftpd"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:23
msgid "Welcome to the FTP wizard. Buckle up."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:30
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:41
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:45
msgid ""
"Exposing the FTP server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad "
"things."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:49
msgid "Server Information"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:52
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:56
msgid ""
"Enter name the sever will use to introduce itself, someone to email "
"complaints too and whether to allow root login access."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:60
msgid "Server Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:63
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:67
msgid ""
"Set listening port, jailed user, allow resumes and/or <acronym>FXP</acronym> "
"(File eXchange Protocol)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:74
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_proftpd.xml:85
msgid "drakwizard-ftp-step6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:10
msgid "Configure proxy"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:12
msgid "drakwizard squid"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:17
msgid "drakwizard_squid.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:23
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard squid</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:22
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can help you to set up a "
"proxy server. It is a component of drakwizard which should be installed "
"before you can access to it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:29
msgid "What is a proxy server?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:31
msgid ""
"A proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application)  that acts "
"as an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other "
"servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service, "
"such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a "
"different server and the proxy server evaluates the request as a way to "
"simplify and control its complexity. (From Wikipedia)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:40
msgid "Setting up a proxy server with drakwizard squid"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:42
msgid "Welcome to the proxy server wizard."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:50
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:60
msgid "Selecting the proxy port"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:64
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:69
msgid ""
"Select the proxy port browsers will connect through, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:74
msgid "Set Memory and Disk Usage"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:78
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:83
msgid "Set memory and disk cache limits, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:88
msgid "Select Network Access Control"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:92
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:97
msgid ""
"Set visibility to local network or world, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:102
msgid "Grant Network Access"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:106
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:111
msgid "Grant access to local networks, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:116
msgid "Use Upper Level Proxy Server?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:120
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:125
msgid "Cascade through another proxy server? If no, skip next step."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:130
msgid "Upper Level Proxy URL and Port"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:134
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:139
msgid ""
"Provide upper level proxy hostname and port, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:148
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:158
msgid "Start during boot?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:162
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step9.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:168
msgid ""
"Choose if the proxy server should be started during the boot time, then "
"click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:177
msgid "drakwizard-proxy-step10.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:193
msgid "Installing the package squid if needed;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:197
msgid ""
"Saving <code>/etc/squid/squid.conf</code> in "
"<code>/etc/squid/squid.conf.orig;</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:202
msgid ""
"Creating a new <code>squid.conf</code> starting from "
"<code>squid.conf.default</code> and adding the new parameters:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:208
msgid "<code>cache_dir</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:212
msgid "<code>localnet</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:216
msgid "cache_mem"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:220
msgid "http_port"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:224
msgid "<code>level</code> 1, 2 or 3 and <code>http_access</code> according to level"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:229
msgid "<code>cache_peer</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:233
msgid "<code>visible_hostname</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/drakwizard_squid.xml:239
msgid "Restarting <code>squid.</code>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:3
msgid "OpenSSH daemon configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:3
msgid "drakwizard sshd"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:8
msgid "drakwizard_sshd.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:13
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakwizard sshd</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:13
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can help you to set up an "
"<acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:16
msgid "What is <acronym>SSH</acronym>?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:18
msgid ""
"Secure Shell (SSH) is a cryptographic network protocol for secure data "
"communication, remote command-line login, remote command execution, and "
"other secure network services between two networked computers that connects, "
"via a secure channel over an insecure network, a server and a client "
"(running SSH server and <acronym>SSH</acronym> client programs, "
"respectively). (From Wikipedia)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:22
msgid "Setting up an <acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon with drakwizard sshd"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:24
msgid "Welcome to the Open SSH wizard."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:28
msgid "Select Type of Configure Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:31
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:35
msgid ""
"Choose <guilabel>Expert</guilabel> for all options or "
"<guilabel>Newbie</guilabel> to skip steps 3-7, click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:39
msgid "General Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:42
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:46
msgid ""
"Sets visibility and root access options. Port 22 is the standard "
"<acronym>SSH</acronym> port."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:50
msgid "Authentication Methods"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:53
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:57
msgid ""
"Allow a variety of authentication methods users can use while connecting, "
"then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:61
msgid "Logging"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:64
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:68
msgid ""
"Choose logging facility and level of output, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:72
msgid "Login Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:75
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:79
msgid "Configure per-login settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:83
msgid "User Login Options"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:86
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:90
msgid "Configure the user access settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><title>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:94
msgid "Compression and Forwarding"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:97
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><procedure><step><para>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:101
msgid ""
"Configure X11 forwarding and compression during transfer, then click "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:108
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><procedure><step><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakwizard_sshd.xml:119
msgid "drakwizard-sshd-step9.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/drakxservices.xml:3
msgid "Manage system services by enabling or disabling them"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/drakxservices.xml:3
msgid "drakxservices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/drakxservices.xml:8
msgid "drakxservices.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/drakxservices.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakxservices</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:10
msgid "Hardware configuration"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:12
msgid "harddrake2"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:17
msgid "harddrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:23
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">harddrake2</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:22
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> gives a general view of "
"the hardware of your computer. When the tool is launched, it executes a job "
"to look for every element of the hardware. For that, it uses the command "
"<code>ldetect </code>which refers to a list of hardware in "
"<code>ldetect-lst</code> package."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:31
msgid "The window"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:33
msgid "The window is divided in two columns."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:35
msgid ""
"The left column contains a list of the detected hardware. The devices are "
"grouped by categories. Click on the &gt; to expand the content of a "
"category. Each device can be selected in this column."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:39
msgid ""
"The right column displays information about the selected device.  The "
"<guimenu>Help -&gt; Fields description</guimenu> gives some information "
"about the content of the fields."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:43
msgid ""
"According to which type of device is selected, either one or two buttons are "
"available at the bottom of the right column:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:48
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Set current driver options</guibutton>: this can be used to "
"parameterize the module which is used in relation to the device. This must "
"used by experts only."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:54
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Run config tool</guibutton>: access to the tool which can "
"configure the device. The tool can often be accessed directly from the MCC."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:68
msgid ""
"The <guimenu>options</guimenu> menu gives the opportunity to check boxes to "
"enable automatic detection:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:73
msgid "modem"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:77
msgid "Jaz devices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:81
msgid "Zip parallel devices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/harddrake2.xml:83
msgid ""
"By default these detections are not enabled, because they are slow. Check "
"the appropriate box(es) if you have this hardware connected. Detection will "
"be operational the next time this tool is started."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:3
msgid "Set up the Keyboard Layout"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:7
msgid "keyboarddrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:12
msgid "keyboarddrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:20
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">keyboarddrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:19
msgid ""
"The keyboarddrake tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> helps you "
"configure the basic layout for the keyboard that you wish to use on "
"Mageia. It affects the keyboard layout for all users on the system. It can "
"be found in the Hardware section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled "
"\"Configure mouse and keyboard\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:29
msgid "Keyboard Layout"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:31
msgid ""
"Here you can select which keyboard layout you wish to use. The names (listed "
"in alphabetical order) describe the language, country, and/or ethnicity each "
"layout should be used for."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:37
msgid "Keyboard Type"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/keyboarddrake.xml:39
msgid ""
"This menu lets you select the type of keyboard you are using. If you are "
"unsure of which to choose, it is best to leave it as the default type."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/localedrake.xml:10
msgid "Manage localization for your system"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/localedrake.xml:13
msgid "localedrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/localedrake.xml:18
msgid "localedrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:24
msgid ""
"You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">localedrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:24
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can be found in the "
"System section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled \"Manage "
"localization for your system\". It opens with a window in which you can "
"choose your language. The choice is adapted to languages selected during "
"installation."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:31
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button give access to activate "
"compatibility with old encoding (non UTF8)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:34
msgid ""
"The second window shows a list of countries according to the selected "
"language. The button <guibutton>Other Countries</guibutton> gives access to "
"countries not listed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:38
msgid "You have to restart your session after any modifications."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><info><title>
#: en/localedrake.xml:42
msgid "Input method"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:44
msgid ""
"In the <guilabel>Other Countries</guilabel> screen you can also select an "
"input method (from the drop-down menu at the bottom of the list). Input "
"methods allow users to input multilingual characters (Chinese, Japanese, "
"Korean, etc)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:48
msgid ""
"For Asian and African locales, IBus will be set as default input method so "
"users should not need to configure it manually."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/localedrake.xml:50
msgid ""
"Other input methods (SCIM, GCIN, HIME, etc.) also provide similar functions "
"and can, if not available from the drop-down menu, be installed in another "
"part of the Mageia Control Center. See <xref linkend=\"rpmdrake\"></xref>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/logdrake.xml:3
msgid "View and search system logs"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/logdrake.xml:5
msgid "logdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/logdrake.xml:10
msgid "logdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">logdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found in the Mageia "
"Control Center System tab, labelled \"<guilabel>View and search system "
"logs</guilabel>\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/logdrake.xml:22
msgid "To do a search in the logs"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:24
msgid ""
"First, enter the key string you want to look for in the <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Matching</emphasis> field and/or the key string you want to "
"<emphasis>do not</emphasis> wish to see amongst the answers in the field "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">but not matching</emphasis>. Then select the file(s)  "
"to search in the <guilabel>Choose file</guilabel> field. Optionally, it is "
"possible to limit the search to only one day. Select it in the <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Calendar</emphasis>, using the little arrows on each side of "
"the month and year, and check \"<guibutton>Show only for the selected "
"day</guibutton>\". At last, click on the <guibutton>search</guibutton> "
"button to see the results in the window called <guilabel>Content of the "
"file</guilabel>. It is possible to save the results in the .txt format by "
"clicking on the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Save</emphasis> button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><note><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:36
msgid ""
"The <guibutton>Mageia Tools Logs</guibutton> houses the logs from the Mageia "
"configuration tools such as the Mageia Control Center tools.  These logs are "
"updated each time a configuration is modified."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/logdrake.xml:43
msgid "To configure a mail alert"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:45
msgid ""
"<guibutton>Mail alert</guibutton> automatically checks the system load and "
"the services every hour and if necessary sends an e-mail to the configured "
"address."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:49
msgid ""
"To configure this tool, click on the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Mail "
"Alert</emphasis> button and then, in the next screen, on the<guibutton> "
"Configure the mail alert system</guibutton> drop down button. Here, all the "
"running services are displayed and you can choose which ones you want to "
"look watch. (See screenshot above)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:55
msgid "The following services can be watched :"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:59
msgid "Webmin Service"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:63
msgid "Postfix Mail Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:67
msgid "FTP Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:71
msgid "Apache World Wide Web Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:75
msgid "SSH Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:79
msgid "Samba Server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:83
msgid "Xinetd Service"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:87
msgid "BIND Domain Name Resolve"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/logdrake.xml:91
msgid "logdrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:97
msgid ""
"In the next screen, select the <guilabel>Load</guilabel> value you consider "
"unacceptable. The load represents the demand to a process, a high load slows "
"the system down and a very high load may indicate that a process has gone "
"out of control. The default value is 3. We recommend setting the load value "
"to 3 times the number of processors."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/logdrake.xml:103
msgid ""
"In the last screen, enter the <guilabel>Email address</guilabel> of the "
"person to be warned and the <guilabel>Email server</guilabel> to use (local "
"or on the Internet)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/lsnetdrake.xml:10
msgid "Display Available NFS And SMB Shares"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/lsnetdrake.xml:11
msgid "lsnetdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/lsnetdrake.xml:16
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">lsnetdrake</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lsnetdrake.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool <placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can only be started and "
"used on the command line."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lsnetdrake.xml:21
msgid ""
"This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you "
"can write this help, please contact <link "
"ns2:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team\"> the "
"Documentation team.</link> Thanking you in advance."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:3
msgid "Display Your PCI, USB and PCMCIA Information"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:6
msgid "lspcidrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:10
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">lspcidrake</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:9
msgid ""
"This tool <placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> can only be started and "
"used on the command line. It will give some more information if used under "
"root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:14
msgid ""
"lspcidrake gives the list of all the connected devices to the computer (USB, "
"PCI and PCMCIA) and the used drivers. It needs the ldetect and ldetect-lst "
"packages to work."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:20
msgid "lspcidrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:24
msgid "With the -v option, lspcidrake adds the vendor and device identifications."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:27
msgid ""
"lspcidrake often generates very long lists, so, to find an information, it "
"is often used in a pipeline with the grep command, like in these examples:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:31
msgid "Information about the graphic card;"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:33
msgid "<command>lspcidrake | grep VGA</command>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:35
msgid "Information about the network"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:37
msgid "<command>lspcidrake | grep -i network</command>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:39
msgid "-i to ignore case distinctions."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:41
msgid ""
"In this screenshot below, you can see the action of the -v option for "
"lspcidrake and the -i option for grep."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:46
msgid "lspcidrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/lspcidrake.xml:50
msgid ""
"There is another tool that gives information about the hardware, it is "
"called <emphasis role=\"bold\">dmidecode</emphasis> (under root)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:3
msgid "Software Packages Update"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:5
msgid "MageiaUpdate or drakrpm-update"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:10
msgid "MageiaUpdate.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">MageiaUpdate</emphasis> or <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">drakrpm-update</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is present in the Mageia "
"Control Center under the tab <emphasis role=\"bold\">Software "
"management.</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:20
msgid ""
"To work, MageiaUpdate needs the repositories to be configured with "
"drakrpm-editmedia with some media checked as updates. If they are not, you "
"are prompted to do so."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:25
msgid ""
"As soon as this tool is launched, it scans the installed packages and lists "
"those with an update available in the repositories. They are all selected by "
"default to be automatically downloaded and installed. Click on the "
"<guibutton>Update</guibutton> button to start the process."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:30
msgid ""
"By clicking on a package, more information is displayed in the lower half of "
"the window. The print<emphasis role=\"bold\"> ></emphasis> before a title "
"means you can click to drop down a text."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><para><inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:38 en/mgaapplet-config.xml:21
msgid "MageiaUpdate1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/MageiaUpdate.xml:35
msgid ""
"When updates are available, an applet in the system tray warns you by "
"displaying this red icon <placeholder type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"0\"/> "
". Just click and enter the user password to update the system alike."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:5
msgid "Boot"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:10
msgid "mcc-boot.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:16
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your boot "
"steps. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:19
msgid "Configure boot steps"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:21
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakautologin\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:25
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakboot\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-boot.xml:29
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakedm\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <article><info><title>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:12 en/MCC.xml:4
msgid "Mageia Control Center"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <book><info><cover><para>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:14
msgid "The tools to configure the Mageia system"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <book><info><cover><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:17
msgid "mageia-2013.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <article><info><cover><para>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:21 en/MCC.xml:6
msgid ""
"The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA "
"3.0 license <link "
"ns6:href=\"http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/\">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <article><info><cover><para>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:24 en/MCC.xml:9
msgid ""
"This manual was produced with the help of the <link "
"ns6:href=\"http://www.calenco.com\">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link "
"ns6:href=\"http://www.neodoc.biz\">NeoDoc</link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <article><info><cover><para>
#: en/MCC-cover.xml:26 en/MCC.xml:11
msgid ""
"It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link "
"ns6:href=\"https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team\">Documentation "
"Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:4
msgid "Hardware"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:9
msgid "mcc-hardware.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:15
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your "
"hardware. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:20
msgid "Manage your hardware"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:22
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"harddrake2\"/><emphasis> = Browse and configure "
"hardware</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:27
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draksound\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:34
msgid "Configure graphics"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:36
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"drak3d\"/><emphasis> = Configure 3D Desktop "
"effects</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:41
msgid "<xref linkend=\"XFdrake\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:48
msgid "Configure mouse and keyboard"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:50
msgid "<xref linkend=\"keyboarddrake\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:54
msgid "<xref linkend=\"mousedrake\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:61
msgid "Configure printing and scanning"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:63
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"system-config-printer\"/><emphasis> = Set up the printer(s), "
"the print job queues, ...</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:68
msgid "<xref linkend=\"scannerdrake\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:75 en/mcc-network.xml:58
msgid "Others"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-hardware.xml:77
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakups\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:3
msgid "About the Manual for the Mageia Control Center"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:6
msgid ""
"The Mageia Control Center (MCC) has eight different options or tabs to "
"choose from in the left column, and even ten if the drakwizard package was "
"installed. Each of these tabs gives a different set of tools that can be "
"selected in the big right panel."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:8
msgid ""
"The ten following chapters are about those ten options and the related "
"tools."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:10
msgid ""
"The last chapter is about some other Mageia tools, that cannot be chosen in "
"any of the MCC tabs."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:12
msgid ""
"The titles of the pages will often be the same as the titles of the tool "
"screens."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-intro.xml:14
msgid ""
"There is also a search bar available, which you can access by clicking on "
"the \"Search\" tab in the left column."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:6 en/mcc-localdisks.xml:17
msgid "Local disks"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:11
msgid "mcc-localdisks.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:15
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several tools to manage or share your "
"local disks. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:18
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakdisk\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:19
msgid "<xref linkend=\"diskdrake--removable\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-localdisks.xml:20
msgid "<xref linkend=\"diskdrake--fileshare\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:4 en/mcc-networkservices.xml:17
msgid "Network Services"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:9
msgid "mcc-networkservices.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:15
msgid ""
"This screen and the one for <emphasis>Sharing</emphasis> are only visible if "
"the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can choose "
"between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link below or "
"on <xref linkend=\"mcc-sharing\"/>to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:19
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_dhcp\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:23
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_bind\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:27
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_squid\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:31
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_ntp\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networkservices.xml:35
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_sshd\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:4
msgid "Network Sharing"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:9
msgid "mcc-networksharing.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:13
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several tools for sharing drives and "
"directories. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:17
msgid "Configure Windows(R) shares"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:18
msgid "<xref linkend=\"diskdrake--smb\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:19
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"draksambashare\"></xref><emphasis> = Share drives and "
"directories with Windows (SMB) systems</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:22
msgid "Configure NFS shares"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:23
msgid "<xref linkend=\"diskdrake--nfs\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:24
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draknfs\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:27
msgid "Configure WebDAV shares"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-networksharing.xml:28
msgid "<xref linkend=\"diskdrake--dav\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:3
msgid "Network and Internet"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:8
msgid "mcc-network.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:12
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several network tools. Click on a link "
"below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:18
msgid "Manage your network devices"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:21
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draknetcenter\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:25
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakconnect\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:29
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakconnect--del\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:36
msgid "Personalize and Secure your network"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:39
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakproxy\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:43
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakgw\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:47
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draknetprofile\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:51
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakvpn\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-network.xml:61
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakhosts\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:5 en/mcc-security.xml:18
msgid "Security"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:10
msgid "mcc-security.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:16
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several security tools. Click on a "
"link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:20
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"msecgui\"/><emphasis> = Configure system security, "
"permissions and audit</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:25
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakfirewall\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:29
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draksec\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:33
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakinvictus\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-security.xml:37
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakguard\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-sharing.xml:4 en/mcc-sharing.xml:17
msgid "Sharing"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-sharing.xml:9
msgid "mcc-sharing.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-sharing.xml:15
msgid ""
"This screen and the one for <emphasis>Network Services</emphasis> are only "
"visible if the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can "
"choose between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link "
"below or on <xref linkend=\"mcc-networkservices\"/>to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-sharing.xml:19
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_proftpd\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-sharing.xml:23
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakwizard_apache2\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:4
msgid "System"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:9
msgid "mcc-system.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:13
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several system and administration "
"tools. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:18
msgid "Manage system services"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:20
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakauth\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:24
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakxservices\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:28
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakfont\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:35
msgid "Localization"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:37
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakclock\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:41
msgid "<xref linkend=\"localedrake\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><title>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:48
msgid "Administration tools"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:50
msgid "<xref linkend=\"logdrake\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:54
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakconsole\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:58
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"userdrake\"></xref><emphasis> = Manage users on "
"system</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:62
msgid "<xref linkend=\"transfugdrake\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/mcc-system.xml:66
msgid "<xref linkend=\"draksnapshot-config\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:3
msgid "Configure updates frequency"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:5
msgid "mgaapplet-config"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:10
msgid "mgaapplet-config.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">mgaapplet-config</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is present in the Mageia "
"Control Center under the tab <emphasis role=\"bold\">Software "
"management</emphasis>. It is also available by a <guimenu>right click / "
"Updates configuration</guimenu> on the red icon <placeholder "
"type=\"inlinemediaobject\" id=\"1\"/> in the system tray."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mgaapplet-config.xml:27
msgid ""
"The first slider allows you to change how frequently Mageia will check for "
"updates and the second the delay after booting before the first check.  The "
"check box gives you the option to be warned when a new Mageia release is "
"out."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:3
msgid "Set up the pointer device (mouse, touchpad)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:6
msgid "mousedrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:11
msgid "mousedrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:15
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">mousedrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:20
msgid ""
"As you must have a mouse to install Mageia, that one is already installed by "
"Drakinstall. This tool allows installation of another mouse."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/mousedrake.xml:23
msgid ""
"The mice are sorted by connection type and then by model. Select your mouse "
"and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Most of the time \"Universal / Any "
"PS/2 &amp; USB mice\" is suitable for a recent mouse. The new mouse is "
"immediately taken into account."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:3
msgid "MSEC: System Security and Audit"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/msecgui.xml:5
msgid "msecgui"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:13
msgid "msecgui.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:21
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">msecgui</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:21
msgid ""
"msecgui<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is a graphic user interface "
"for msec that allows to configure your system security according to two "
"approaches:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:28
msgid ""
"It sets the system behaviour, msec imposes modifications to the system to "
"make it more secure."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:33
msgid ""
"It carries on periodic checks automatically on the system in order to warn "
"you if something seems dangerous."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:38
msgid ""
"msec uses the concept of \"security levels\" which are intended to configure "
"a set of system permissions, which can be audited for changes or "
"enforcement. Several of them are proposed by Mageia, but you can define your "
"own customised security levels."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:45
msgid "Overview tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:47
msgid "See the screenshot above"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:49
msgid ""
"The first tab takes up the list of the different security tools with a "
"button on the right side to configure them:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:54
msgid "Firewall, also found in the MCC / Security / Set up your personal firewall"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:59
msgid "Updates, also found in MCC / Software Management / Update your system"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:64
msgid "msec itself with some information:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:68
msgid "enabled or not"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:72
msgid "the configured Base security level"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:76
msgid ""
"the date of the last Periodic checks and a button to see a detailed report "
"and another button to execute the checks just now."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:86
msgid "Security settings tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:88
msgid ""
"A click on the second tab or on the Security "
"<guibutton>Configure</guibutton> button leads to the same screen shown "
"below."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:94
msgid "msecgui2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:100
msgid "Basic security tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:103
msgid "<emphasis role=\"underline\">Security levels:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:106
msgid ""
"After having checked the box <guilabel>Enable MSEC tool</guilabel>, this tab "
"allows you by a double click to choose the security level that appears then "
"in bold. If the box is not checked, the level « none » is applied. The "
"following levels are available:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:113
msgid ""
"Level <emphasis role=\"bold\">none</emphasis>. This level is intended if you "
"do not want to use msec to control system security, and prefer tuning it on "
"your own. It disables all security checks and puts no restrictions or "
"constraints on system configuration and settings. Please use this level only "
"if you are knowing what you are doing, as it would leave your system "
"vulnerable to attack."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:122
msgid ""
"Level <emphasis role=\"bold\">standard</emphasis>. This is the default "
"configuration when installed and is intended for casual users.  It "
"constrains several system settings and executes daily security checks which "
"detect changes in system files, system accounts, and vulnerable directory "
"permissions. (This level is similar to levels 2 and 3 from past msec "
"versions)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:131
msgid ""
"Level <emphasis role=\"bold\">secure</emphasis>. This level is intended when "
"you want to ensure your system is secure, yet usable.  It further restricts "
"system permissions and executes more periodic checks. Moreover, access to "
"the system is more restricted. (This level is similar to levels 4 (High) and "
"5 (Paranoid) from old msec versions)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:140
msgid ""
"Besides those levels, different task-oriented security are also provided, "
"such as the <emphasis role=\"bold\">fileserver </emphasis>, <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">webserver</emphasis> and <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">netbook</emphasis> levels. Such levels attempt to "
"pre-configure system security according to the most common use cases."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:149
msgid ""
"The last two levels called <emphasis role=\"bold\">audit_daily </emphasis> "
"and <emphasis role=\"bold\">audit_weekly</emphasis> are not really security "
"levels but rather tools for periodic checks only."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:156
msgid ""
"These levels are saved in "
"<filename>etc/security/msec/level.&lt;levelname></filename>. You can define "
"your own customised security levels, saving them into specific files called "
"<filename>level.&lt;levelname></filename>, placed into the folder "
"<filename>etc/security/msec/.</filename> This function is intended for power "
"users which require a customised or more secure system configuration."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><caution><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:165
msgid ""
"Keep in mind that user-modified parameters take precedence over default "
"level settings."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:170
msgid "<emphasis role=\"underline\">Security alerts:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:173
msgid ""
"If you check the box <guibutton>Send security alerts by email "
"to:</guibutton>, the security alerts generated by msec are going to be sent "
"by local e-mail to the security administrator named in the nearby field. You "
"can fill either a local user or a complete e-mail address (the local e-mail "
"and the e-mail manager must be set accordingly). At last, you can receive "
"the security alerts directly on your desktop.  Check the relevant box to "
"enable it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><important><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:182
msgid ""
"It is strongly advisable to enable the security alerts option in order to "
"immediately inform the security administrator of possible security "
"problems. If not, the administrator will have to regularly check the logs "
"files available in <filename>/var/log/security.</filename>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:188
msgid "<emphasis role=\"underline\">Security options:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:190
msgid ""
"Creating a customised level is not the only way to customise the computer "
"security, it is also possible to use the tabs presented here after to change "
"any option you want. Current configuration for msec is stored in "
"<filename>/etc/security/msec/security.conf</filename>. This file contains "
"the current security level name and the list of all the modifications done "
"to the options."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:199
msgid "System security tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:201
msgid ""
"This tab displays all the security options on the left side column, a "
"description in the centre column, and their current values on the right side "
"column."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:207
msgid "msecgui3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:211
msgid ""
"To modify an option, double click on it and a new window appears (see "
"screenshot below). It displays the option name, a short description, the "
"actual and default values, and a drop down list where the new value can be "
"selected. Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the "
"choice."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:219
msgid "msecgui11.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><caution><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:224
msgid ""
"Do not forget when leaving msecgui to save definitively your configuration "
"using the menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you "
"have changed the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before "
"saving them."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:232
msgid "msecgui10.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:238
msgid "Network security"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:240
msgid "This tab displays all the network options and works like the previous tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:245
msgid "msecgui4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:251
msgid "Periodic checks tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:253
msgid ""
"Periodic checks aim to inform the security administrator by means of "
"security alerts of all situations msec thinks potentially dangerous."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:257
msgid ""
"This tab displays all the periodic checks done by msec and their frequency "
"if the box <guibutton>Enable periodic security checks</guibutton> is "
"checked. Changes are done like in the previous tabs."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:264
msgid "msecgui5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:270
msgid "Exceptions tab"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:272
msgid ""
"Sometimes alert messages are due to well known and wanted situations. In "
"these cases they are useless and wasted time for the administrator. This tab "
"allows you to create as many exceptions as you want to avoid unwanted alert "
"messages. It is obviously empty at the first msec start. The screenshot "
"below shows four exceptions."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:280
msgid "msecgui6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:284
msgid ""
"To create an exception, click on the <guibutton>Add a rule</guibutton> "
"button"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:289
msgid "msecgui7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:293
msgid ""
"Select the wanted periodic check in the drop down list called "
"<guilabel>Check</guilabel> and then, enter the "
"<guilabel>Exception</guilabel> in the text area. Adding an exception is "
"obviously not definitive, you can either delete it using the "
"<guibutton>Delete</guibutton> button of the <guilabel>Exceptions</guilabel> "
"tab or modify it with a double clicK."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><title>
#: en/msecgui.xml:303
msgid "Permissions"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:304
msgid ""
"This tab is intended for file and directory permissions checking and "
"enforcement."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:306
msgid ""
"Like for the security, msec owns different permissions levels (standard, "
"secure, ..), they are enabled accordingly with the chosen security "
"level. You can create your own customised permissions levels, saving them "
"into specific files called <filename>perm.&lt;levelname> </filename> placed "
"into the folder <filename>etc/security/msec/</filename> . This function is "
"intended for power users which require a customised configuration. It is "
"also possible to use the tab presented here after to change any permission "
"you want. Current configuration is stored in "
"<filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf.</filename> This file contains the "
"list of all the modifications done to the permissions."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:318
msgid "msecgui8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:321
msgid ""
"Default permissions are visible as a list of rules (a rule per line). You "
"can see on the left side, the file or folder concerned by the rule, then the "
"owner, then the group and then the permissions given by the rule. If, for a "
"given rule:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:327
msgid ""
"the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is not checked, msec only checks if the "
"defined permissions for this rule are respected and sends an alert message "
"if not, but does not change anything."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:333
msgid ""
"the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is checked, then msec will rule the "
"permissions respect at the first periodic check and overwrite the "
"permissions."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><important><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:337
msgid ""
"For this to work, the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Periodic check tab</emphasis> must be configured accordingly."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:339
msgid ""
"To create a new rule, click on the <guibutton> Add a rule</guibutton> button "
"and fill the fields as shown in the example below. The joker * is allowed in "
"the <guilabel>File</guilabel> field. “current” means no modification."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/msecgui.xml:345
msgid "msecgui9.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:348
msgid ""
"Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the choice and do "
"not forget when leaving to save definitively your configuration using the "
"menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you have changed "
"the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before saving them."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><note><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:353
msgid ""
"It is also possible to create or modify the rules by editing the "
"configuration file <filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf</filename>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><caution><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:356
msgid ""
"Changes in the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Permission tab</emphasis> (or "
"directly in the configuration file) are taken into account at the first "
"periodic check (see the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Periodic checks tab</emphasis>). If you want them to be taken "
"immediately into account, use the msecperms command in a console with root "
"rights. You can use before, the msecperms -p command to know the permissions "
"that will be changed by msecperms."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><section><caution><para>
#: en/msecgui.xml:363
msgid ""
"Do not forget that if you modify the permissions in a console or in a file "
"manager, for a file where the box <guilabel>Enforce </guilabel> is checked "
"in the <emphasis role=\"bold\">Permissions tab </emphasis>, msecgui will "
"write the old permissions back after a while, accordingly to the "
"configuration of the options CHECK_PERMS and CHECK_PERMS_ENFORCE in the "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Periodic Checks tab </emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:4
msgid "Other Mageia Tools"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:7
msgid ""
"There are more Mageia tools than those that can be started in the Mageia "
"Control Center. Click on a link below to learn more, or continue reading the "
"next pages."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:11
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakbug\"/><emphasis>drakbug</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:16
msgid "<xref linkend=\"drakbug_report\"/><emphasis>drakbug_report </emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:21
msgid "<xref linkend=\"lsnetdrake\"/><emphasis>TO BE WRITTEN </emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:25
msgid "<xref linkend=\"lspcidrake\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/otherMageiaTools.xml:29
msgid "And more tools?"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:3
msgid "Software Management (Install and Remove Software)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:6
msgid "rpmdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:11
msgid "rpmdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:18
msgid "Introduction to rpmdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:21
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">rpmdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:20
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/>, also known as drakrpm, "
"is a program for installing, uninstalling and updating packages. It is the "
"graphical user interface of URPMI. At each start up, it will check online "
"package lists (called 'media') downloaded straight from Mageia's official "
"servers, and will show you each time the latest applications and packages "
"available for your computer. A filter system allows you to display only "
"certain types of packages: you may display only installed applications (by "
"default), or only available updates. You can also view only not installed "
"packages. You can also search by the name of a package, or in the summaries "
"of descriptions or in the full descriptions of packages or in the file names "
"included in the packages."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:35
msgid ""
"To work, rpmdrake needs the repositories to be configured with <xref "
"linkend=\"drakrpm-edit-media\"/> ."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><important><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:43
msgid "rpmdrake8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><important><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:38
msgid ""
"During the installation, the configured repository is the medium used for "
"the installation, generally the DVD or CD. If you keep this medium, rpmdrake "
"will ask it each time you want to install a package, with this pop-up window "
": <placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>If the above message annoys "
"you and you have a good internet connection without too strict download "
"limit, it is wise to remove that medium and replace it by online "
"repositories thanks to <xref linkend=\"drakrpm-edit-media\"/> ."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><important><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:49
msgid ""
"Moreover, the online repositories are always up to date, contains much more "
"packages, and allow to update your installed packages."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:55
msgid "The main parts of the screen"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><screenshot><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:60
msgid "rpmdrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:67
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Package type filter:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:69
msgid ""
"This filter allows you to display only certain types of packages. The first "
"time you start the manager, it only displays applications with a graphical "
"interface. You can display either all the packages and all their "
"dependencies and libraries or only package groups such as applications only, "
"updates only or backported packages from newer versions of Mageia."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><warning><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:77
msgid ""
"The default filter setting is for new entrants to Linux or Mageia, who "
"probably do not want command line or specialist tools.  Since you're reading "
"this documentation, you're obviously interested in improving your knowledge "
"of Mageia, so it is best to set this filter to \"All\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:86
msgid ""
"<firstterm> <emphasis role=\"bold\">Package state filter:</emphasis> "
"</firstterm>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:89
msgid ""
"This filter allows you to view only the installed packages, only the "
"packages that are not installed or all of the packages, both installed and "
"not installed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:95
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Search mode:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:97
msgid ""
"Click on this icon to search through the package names, through their "
"summaries, through their complete description or through the files included "
"in the packages."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:103
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">\"Find\" box:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:105
msgid ""
"Enter here one or more key words. If you want to use more than one keyword "
"for searching use '|' between keywords, e.g. To search for \"mplayer\" and "
"\"xine\" at the same time type 'mplayer | xine'."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:111
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Erase all:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:113
msgid ""
"This icon can erase in one click all the key words entered in the \"Find\" "
"box ."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:118
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Categories list:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:120
msgid ""
"This side bar groups all applications and packages into clear categories and "
"sub categories."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:125
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Description panel:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:127
msgid ""
"This panel displays the package's name, its summary and complete "
"description. It displays many useful elements about the selected package. It "
"can also show precise details about the package, the files included in the "
"package as well as a list of the last changes made by the maintainer."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:137
msgid "The status column"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:139
msgid ""
"Once you correctly set the filters, you can find your software either by "
"category (in area 6 above) or by name/summary/description using area 4. A "
"list of packages fulfilling your query and, don't forget, the chosen medium "
"is shown with different status markers according to whether each package is "
"installed/not installed/an update... To change this status, just check or "
"uncheck the box before the package name and click on "
"<guibutton>Apply</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><thead><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:155
msgid "Icon"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><thead><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:157
msgid "Legend"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:165
msgid "../rpmdrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:169
msgid "This package is already installed"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:175
msgid "../rpmdrake3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:179
msgid "This package will be installed"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:185
msgid "../rpmdrake4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:189
msgid "This package cannot be modified"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:195
msgid "../rpmdrake5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:199
msgid "This package is an update"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:205
msgid "../rpmdrake6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><table><tgroup><tbody><row><entry>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:209
msgid "This package will be uninstalled"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:147
msgid "<placeholder type=\"table\" id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:215
msgid "Examples in the screenshot above:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:219
msgid ""
"If I uncheck digikam (the green arrow tell us it is installed), the status "
"icon will go red with an up arrow and it will be uninstalled when clicking "
"on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:227
msgid ""
"If I check qdigidoc (which is not installed, see the status), the orange "
"with a down arrow status icon will appear and it will be installed when "
"clicking on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:235
msgid "The dependencies"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><screenshot><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:240
msgid "rpmdrake7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/rpmdrake.xml:245
msgid ""
"Some packages need other packages called dependencies in order to work. They "
"are for example libraries or tools. In this case, Rpmdrake displays an "
"information window allowing you to choose whether to accept the selected "
"dependencies, cancel the operation or get more information (see above). It "
"may also happen that various packages are able to provide the needed "
"library, in which case rpmdrake displays the list of alternatives with a "
"button to get more information and another button to choose which package to "
"install."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:10
msgid "Set up scanner"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:11
msgid "scannerdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><info><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:18
msgid "Installation"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:22
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing "
"<emphasis>scannerdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:21
msgid ""
"This tool <placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> allows you to configure "
"a single scanner device or a multifunction device which includes "
"scanning. It also allows you to share local devices connected to this "
"computer with a remote computer or to access remote scanners."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:29
msgid ""
"When you start this tool for the first time, you may get the following "
"message:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:32
msgid "<emphasis>\"SANE packages need to be installed to use scanners</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:35
msgid "<emphasis>Do you want to install the SANE packages?\"</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:38
msgid ""
"Choose <emphasis>Yes</emphasis> to continue. It will install "
"<code>scanner-gui</code> and <code>task-scanning</code> if they are not yet "
"installed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:44
msgid "scannerdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:50
msgid ""
"If your scanner is identified correctly, so if in the above screen you see "
"the name of your scanner, the scanner is ready for use with, for instance, "
"<emphasis>XSane</emphasis> or <emphasis>Simple Scan</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:55
msgid ""
"In that case, you might now want to want to configure the <emphasis>Scanner "
"sharing</emphasis> option. You can read about it in the <xref "
"linkend=\"scannersharing\"/>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:59
msgid ""
"However, if your scanner hasn't been correctly identified, and checking its "
"cable(s) and power switch and then pressing <emphasis>Search for new "
"scanners</emphasis> doesn't help, you'll need to press <emphasis>Add a "
"scanner manually</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:64
msgid ""
"Choose the brand of your scanner in the list you see, then its type from the "
"list for that brand and click <emphasis>Ok</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:69
msgid "scannerdrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><note><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:76
msgid ""
"If you can't find your scanner in the list, then click "
"<emphasis>Cancel</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><note><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:79
msgid ""
"Please check whether your scanner is supported on the <link "
"xlink:href=\"http://www.sane-project.org/lists/sane-mfgs-cvs.html\">SANE: "
"Supported Devices</link> page and ask for help in the <link "
"xlink:href=\"http://forums.mageia.org/en/\">forums</link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><figure><info><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:87
msgid "Choose port"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><figure><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:91
msgid "scannerdrake3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><figure>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:86
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"info\" id=\"0\"/> <placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" "
"id=\"1\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:97
msgid ""
"You can leave this setting to <emphasis>Auto-detect available "
"ports</emphasis> unless your scanner's interface is a parallel port. In that "
"case, select <emphasis>/dev/parport0</emphasis> if you have only one."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:102
msgid ""
"After clicking <emphasis>Ok</emphasis>, in most cases you will see a screen "
"similar to the one below."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:104
msgid ""
"If you don't get that screen, then please read the <xref "
"linkend=\"scannerextrasteps\"/>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:108
msgid "scannerdrake4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><info><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:117
msgid "Scannersharing"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:122
msgid "scannerdrake5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:128
msgid ""
"Here you can choose whether the scanners connected to this machine should be "
"accessible by remote machines and by which remote machines. You can also "
"decide here whether scanners on remote machines should be made available on "
"this machine."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:133
msgid ""
"Scanner sharing to hosts : name or IP address of hosts can be added or "
"deleted from the list of hosts allowed to access the local device(s), on "
"this computer."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:137
msgid ""
"Usage of remote scanners : name or IP address of hosts can added or deleted "
"from the list of hosts which give access to a remote scanner."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:143
msgid "scannerdrake6.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:149
msgid "Scanner sharing to hosts: you can add host."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:153
msgid "scannerdrake7.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:159
msgid ""
"Scanner sharing to hosts: specify which host(s) to add, or allow all remote "
"machines."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:164
msgid "scannerdrake8.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:170
msgid "\"All remote machines\" are allowed to access the local scanner."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:175
msgid "scannerdrake9.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:181
msgid ""
"If the package <emphasis>saned</emphasis> is not yet installed, the tool "
"offers to do it."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:184
msgid "At the end, the tool will alter these files:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:186
msgid "<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/saned.conf</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:188
msgid "<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/net.conf</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:190
msgid ""
"<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/dll.conf </emphasis>to add or comment the directive "
"\"net\""
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:193
msgid ""
"It will also configure <emphasis>saned</emphasis> and "
"<emphasis>xinetd</emphasis> to be started on boot."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:199 en/system-config-printer.xml:278
msgid "Specifics"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:205
msgid "Hewlett-Packard"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:207
msgid ""
"Most HP scanners are managed from <emphasis>HP Device Manager</emphasis> "
"(hplip) which also manages printers. In this case, this tool does not allow "
"you to configure it and invites you to use <emphasis>HP Device "
"Manager</emphasis>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:214
msgid "Epson"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:216
msgid ""
"Drivers are available from <link "
"xlink:href=\"http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX\">this "
"page</link>. When indicated, you must install the "
"<emphasis>iscan-data</emphasis> package first, then "
"<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> (in this order). It is possible that the "
"<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> package will generate a warning about a conflict "
"with <emphasis>sane</emphasis>. Users have reported that this warning can be "
"ignored."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><info><title>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:231
msgid "Extra installation steps"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:234
msgid ""
"It is possible that after selecting a port for your scanner in the <xref "
"linkend=\"choosescannerport\"/> screen, you need to take one or more extra "
"steps to correctly configure your scanner."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:239
msgid ""
"In some cases, you're told the scanner needs its firmware to be uploaded "
"each time it is started. This tool allows you to load it into the device, "
"after you installed it on your system. In this screen you can install the "
"firmware from a CD or a Windows installation, or install the one you "
"downloaded from an Internet site of the vendor."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:241
msgid ""
"When your device's firmware needs to be loaded, it can take a long time at "
"each first usage, possibly more than one minute. So be patient."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:246
msgid ""
"Also, you may get a screen telling you to adjust the "
"<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/\"name_of_your_SANE_backend\".conf file.</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/scannerdrake.xml:250
msgid ""
"Read those or other instructions you get carefully and if you don't know "
"what to do, feel free to ask for help in the <link "
"xlink:href=\"http://forums.mageia.org/en/\">forums</link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/software-management.xml:5 en/software-management.xml:15
msgid "Software Management"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/software-management.xml:10
msgid "software-management.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/software-management.xml:14
msgid ""
"In this screen you can choose between several tools for software "
"management. Click on a link below to learn more."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/software-management.xml:17
msgid "<xref linkend=\"rpmdrake\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/software-management.xml:20
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"MageiaUpdate\"></xref><emphasis> = Update your "
"system</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/software-management.xml:23
msgid "<xref linkend=\"mgaapplet-config\"></xref>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/software-management.xml:26
msgid ""
"<xref linkend=\"drakrpm-edit-media\"></xref><emphasis> = Configure media "
"sources for install and update</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:8
msgid "Install and configure a printer"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:11
msgid "system-config-printer"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:16
msgid "system-config-printer.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:23
msgid ""
"Printing is managed on Mageia by a server named CUPS. It has its own <link "
"ns2:title=\"CUPS\" ns2:href=\"http://localhost:631\">configuration "
"interface</link> which is accessible via an Internet browser, but Mageia "
"offers its own tool for installing printers called system-config-printer "
"which is shared with other distributions such as Fedora, Mandriva, Ubuntu "
"and openSUSE."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:30
msgid ""
"You should enable the non-free repository before proceeding with the "
"installation, because some drivers may only be available in this way."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:37
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing "
"<emphasis>system-config-printer</emphasis>. The root password will be asked "
"for."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:34
msgid ""
"Printer installation is carried out in the <guilabel>Hardware</guilabel> "
"section of the Mageia Control Centre. Select the <guilabel>Configure "
"printing and scanning</guilabel> tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" "
"id=\"0\"/>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:42
msgid "MCC will ask for the installation two packages:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><blockquote><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:45
msgid "task-printing-server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><blockquote><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:47
msgid "task-printing-hp"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:50
msgid ""
"It is necessary to accept this installation to continue. Up to 230MB of "
"dependencies are needed."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:53
msgid ""
"To add a printer, choose the \"Add\" printer button. The system will try to "
"detect any printers and the ports available. The screenshot displays a "
"printer connected to a parallel port. If a printer is detected, such as a "
"printer on a USB port, it will be displayed on the first line.  The window "
"will also attempt to configure a network printer."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:61
msgid "Automatically detected printer"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:63
msgid ""
"This usually refers to USB printers. The utility automatically finds the "
"name of the printer and displays it. Select the printer and then click "
"\"Next\". If there is a known driver associated for the printer, it will be "
"automatically installed. If there is more than one driver or no known "
"drivers, a window will ask you to select or furnish one, as explained in the "
"next paragraph. Continue with <xref linkend=\"terminate\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:72
msgid "No automatically detected printer"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:76
msgid "printer3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:80
msgid ""
"When you select a port, the system loads a driver list and displays a window "
"to select a driver. The choice can be made through one of the following "
"options."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:86
msgid "Select printer from database"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:92
msgid "provide PPD file"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:98
msgid "search for a driver to download"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:102
msgid ""
"By selecting from the database, the window suggests a printer manufacturer "
"first, and then a device and a driver associated with it. If more than one "
"driver is suggested, select one which is recommended, unless you have "
"encountered some problems with that one before, in this case select the one "
"which know to work."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:110
msgid "Complete the installation process"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:112
msgid ""
"After the driver selection, a window requests some information which will "
"allow the system to designate and discover the printer. The first line is "
"the name under which the device will appear in applications in the list of "
"available printers. The installer then suggests printing a test page. After "
"this step, the printer is added and appears in the list of available "
"printers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:121
msgid "Network printer"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:123
msgid ""
"Network printers are printers that are attached directly to a wired or "
"wireless network, that are attached to a printserver or that are attached to "
"another workstation that serves as printserver."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><note><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:128
msgid ""
"Often, it is better to configure the DHCP server to always associate a fixed "
"IP address with the printer's MAC-address. Of course that should be the same "
"as the IP address the printer of printserver is set to, if it has a fixed "
"one."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:134
msgid ""
"The printer's Mac-address is a serial number given to the printer or "
"printserver or computer it is attached to, that can be obtained from a "
"configuration page printed by the printer or which may be written on a label "
"on the printer or printserver. If your shared printer is attached to a "
"Mageia system, you can run <emphasis><code>ifconfig</code></emphasis> on it "
"as root to find the MAC-address. It is the sequence of numbers and letters "
"after \"HWaddr\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:142
msgid ""
"You can add your network printer by choosing the protocol it uses to talk to "
"your computer over the network. If you don't know which protocol to choose, "
"you can try the <guilabel>Network Printer</guilabel> - <guilabel>Find "
"Network Printer</guilabel> option in the <guilabel>Devices</guilabel> menu "
"and give the IP address of the printer in the box on the right, where it "
"says \"host\"."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:149
msgid ""
"If the tool recognises your printer or printserver, it will propose a "
"protocol and a queue, but you can choose a more appropriate one from the "
"list below it or give the correct queue name if it isn't in the list."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:154
msgid ""
"Look in the documentation that came with your printer or printserver to find "
"which protocol(s) it supports and for possible specific queue names."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:160
msgid "Network printing protocols"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:162
msgid ""
"One current technique is one developed by Hewlett-Packard and known as "
"JetDirect. It allows access to a printer directly connected to the network "
"via an Ethernet port. You must know the IP-address at which the printer is "
"known on the network. This technique is also used inside some ADSL-routers "
"which contain an USB port to connect the printer. In this case, the "
"IP-address is that of the router. Note that the tool \"Hp Device manager\" "
"can manage dynamically configured IP-adress, setting an URI like "
"<emphasis>hp:/net/&lt;name-of-the-printer></emphasis> . In this case, fixed "
"IP-adress is not required."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:172
msgid ""
"Choose the option <guilabel>AppSocket/HP JetDirect</guilabel> as the "
"protocol and set the address in <guilabel>Host:</guilabel>, do not change "
"the <guilabel>Port Number</guilabel>, unless you know that it needs to be "
"changed. After the selection of the protocol, the selection of the driver is "
"the same as above."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:180
msgid "printer5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:184
msgid "The other protocols are:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:188
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipp)</emphasis>: a printer which can "
"be accessed on a TCP/IP network via the IPP protocol, for example a printer "
"connected to a station using CUPS. This protocol may also be used also by "
"some ADSL-routers."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:197
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (https): </emphasis>the same as ipp, "
"but using http transport and with TLS secured protocol.  The port has to be "
"defined. By default, the port 631 is used."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:205
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipps): </emphasis>the same as ipp, but "
"with TLS secured protocol."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:212
msgid ""
"<emphasis>LPD/LPR host or Printer</emphasis>: a printer which can be "
"accessed on a TCP/IP network via the LPD protocol, for example a printer "
"connected to a station using LPD."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:220
msgid ""
"<emphasis>Windows printer via SAMBA</emphasis>: a printer connected to a "
"station running Windows or a SMB server and shared."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:226
msgid ""
"The URI can also be added directly. Here are some examples on how to form "
"the URI:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:231
msgid "Appsocket"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:233
msgid "<uri>socket://ip-address-or-hostname:port </uri>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:237
msgid "Internet Printing Protocol (IPP)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:239
msgid "<uri>ipp://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:241
msgid "<uri>http://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:245
msgid "Line Printer Daemon (LPD) Protocol"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><itemizedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:247
msgid "<uri>lpd://username@ip-address-or-hostname/queue</uri>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:251
msgid ""
"Additional information can be found in the <link "
"ns2:href=\"http://www.cups.org/documentation.php/doc-1.5/network.html\">CUPS "
"documentation.</link>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:256
msgid "Device Properties"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:258
msgid ""
"You can access the properties of the device. The menu allows access to "
"parameters for the CUPS server. By default a CUPS server is launched on your "
"system, but you can specify a different one with the "
"<guimenu>Server</guimenu> | <guimenuitem>Connect...</guimenuitem> menu, "
"another window which gives access to the tuning of other specific parameters "
"of the server, following <guimenu>Server</guimenu> | "
"<guimenuitem>Settings.</guimenuitem>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><title>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:268
msgid "Troubleshoot"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:270
msgid ""
"You can find some information on occurring errors during printing by "
"inspecting <filename>/var/log/cups/error_log</filename>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:273
msgid ""
"You can also access to a tool to diagnose problems using the "
"<guimenu>Help</guimenu> | <guilabel>Troubleshoot</guilabel> menu."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:280
msgid ""
"It is possible that some drivers for specific printers are not available in "
"Mageia or are not functional. In this case, have a look at the <link "
"ns2:href=\"http://openprinting.org/printers/\">openprinting</link> site to "
"check if a driver for your device is available. If yes, check if the package "
"is already present in Mageia and in this case install it manually. Then, "
"redo the installation process to configure the printer. In all cases, report "
"the problem in bugzilla or on the forum if you are comfortable with this "
"tool and furnish the model and driver information and whether the printer "
"works or not after installation. Here are some sources to find other "
"up-to-date drivers or for more recent devices."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:292
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Brother printers</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:294
msgid ""
"<link "
"ns2:href=\"http://welcome.solutions.brother.com/bsc/public_s/id/linux/en/download_prn.html\">This "
"page</link> give a list of drivers provided by Brother. Search the driver "
"for your device, download the rpm(s) and install."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:298
msgid "You should install Brother drivers before running the configuration utility."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:301
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Hewlett-Packard printers and All in one "
"devices</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:304
msgid ""
"These devices use the hplip tool. It is installed automatically after the "
"detection or the selection of the printer. You can find other information "
"<link "
"ns2:href=\"http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/index.html\">here</link>.  "
"The tool \"HP Device Manager\" is available in the "
"<guilabel>System</guilabel> menu. Also view <link "
"ns2:href=\"http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/install/manual/hp_setup.html\">configuration</link> "
"for the management of the printer."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:311
msgid ""
"A HP All in one device must be installed as a printer and the scanner "
"features will be added. Note that sometimes, the Xsane interface doesn't "
"allow to scan films or slides (the lighting slid can't operate).  In this "
"case, it is possible to scan, using the standalone mode, and save the "
"picture on a memory card or USB stick inserted in the device.  Afterwards, "
"open your favourite imaging software and load your picture from the memory "
"card which is appeared in the /media folder."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:319
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Samsung colour printer</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:321
msgid ""
"For specific Samsung and Xerox colour printers, <link "
"ns2:href=\"http://foo2qpdl.rkkda.com/\">this site provides drivers</link> "
"for the QPDL protocol."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:324
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Epson printers and scanners</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:326
msgid ""
"Drivers for Epson printers are available from <link "
"ns2:href=\"http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX\">this "
"search page</link>. For the scanner part, you must install the "
"\"iscan-data\" package first, then \"iscan\" (in this order). A iscan-plugin "
"package can also be available and is to install. Choose the "
"<emphasis>rpm</emphasis> packages according to your architecture."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:332
msgid ""
"It is possible that the iscan package will generate a warning about a "
"conflict with sane. Users have reported that this warning can be ignored."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:336
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Canon printers</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><section><para>
#: en/system-config-printer.xml:338
msgid ""
"For Canon printers, it may be advisable to install a tool named turboprint "
"<link ns2:href=\"http://www.turboprint.info/\">available here </link>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:9
msgid "Import Windows(TM) documents and settings"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:12
msgid "transfugdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:17
msgid "transfugdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:22
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">transfugdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:21
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found under the "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center "
"labeled <guilabel>Import Windows(TM) documents and settings</guilabel>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:27
msgid ""
"The tool allows an administrator to import the user documents and settings "
"from a <trademark class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> 2000, <trademark "
"class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> XP or <trademark "
"class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> <trademark>Vista</trademark> "
"installation on the same computer as the Mageia installation."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:33
msgid ""
"Please note that all the changes will be applied by transfugdrake "
"immediately after pressing <guibutton>Next</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:37
msgid ""
"After starting transfugdrake you will see the first wizard page with some "
"explanation about the tool and import options."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:40
msgid ""
"As soon as you read and understand the instructions, press the "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. This should run a detection of "
"<trademark class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> installation."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:44
msgid ""
"When the detection step is complete you will see a page which allows you to "
"choose accounts in <trademark class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> and "
"Mageia for the import procedure. It is possible to choose other user account "
"than yours own."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:51
msgid "transfugdrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:56
msgid ""
"Please take into account that due to migrate-assistant (the backend of "
"transfugdrake) limitations <trademark "
"class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> user account names with special "
"symbols can be displayed incorrectly."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:62
msgid "Migration may take some time depending on the size of the document folders."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:67
msgid ""
"Some <trademark class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> applications "
"(especially drivers) may create user accounts for different purposes. For "
"example, NVidia drivers in <trademark "
"class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark>are updated using "
"<emphasis>UpdatusUser</emphasis>. Please do not use such accounts for the "
"import purposes."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:74
msgid ""
"When you finished with the accounts selection press "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method "
"to import documents:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:80
msgid "transfugdrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:84
msgid ""
"Transfugdrake is designed to import <trademark "
"class=\"registered\">Windows</trademark> data from <emphasis>My "
"Documents</emphasis>, <emphasis>My Music</emphasis> and <emphasis>My "
"Pictures</emphasis> folders. It is possible to skip import by selecting the "
"appropriate item in this window."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:89
msgid ""
"When you finished with the document import method choosing press "
"<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method "
"to import bookmarks:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:95
msgid "transfugdrake3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:99
msgid ""
"Transfugdrake can import <emphasis>Internet Explorer</emphasis> and "
"<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> bookmarks into the bookmarks of Mageia "
"<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> instance."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:103
msgid ""
"Choose the preferred import option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> "
"button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:112
msgid "The next page allows you to import desktop background:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:116
msgid "transfugdrake4.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:120
msgid ""
"Choose the preferred option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> "
"button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:123
msgid ""
"The last page of wizard shows some congratulation message. Just press the "
"<guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/transfugdrake.xml:128
msgid "transfugdrake5.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/userdrake.xml:11
msgid "Users and Groups"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/userdrake.xml:13
msgid "userdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/userdrake.xml:18
msgid "userdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:23
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">userdrake</emphasis> as root."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:22
msgid ""
"This tool<placeholder type=\"footnote\" id=\"0\"/> is found under the "
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center "
"labelled \"Manage users on system\""
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:27
msgid ""
"The tool allows an administrator to manage the users and the groups, this "
"means to add or delete a user or group and to modify user and group settings "
"(ID, shell, ...)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:31
msgid ""
"When userdrake is opened, all the users existing on the system are listed in "
"the <guibutton>Users</guibutton> tab, and all the groups in the "
"<guibutton>Groups</guibutton> tab. Both tabs operate the same way."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:35
msgid "<guibutton>1 Add User</guibutton>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:37
msgid "This button opens a new window with all fields shown empty:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/userdrake.xml:41
msgid "userdrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:45
msgid ""
"The field <emphasis role=\"bold\">Full Name</emphasis> is intended for the "
"entry of a family name and first name, but it is possible to write anything "
"or nothing as well!"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:49
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Login</emphasis> is the only required field."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:52
msgid ""
"Setting a <emphasis role=\"bold\">Password</emphasis> is highly "
"recommended. There is a little shield on the right, if it is red, the "
"password is weak, too short or is too similar to the login name. You should "
"use figures, lower and upper case characters, punctuation marks, etc. The "
"shield will turn orange and then green as the password strength improves."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:59
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Confirm Password</emphasis> field is there to ensure "
"you entered what you intended to."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:62
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Login Shell </emphasis>is a drop down list that "
"allows you to change the shell used by the user you are adding, the options "
"are Bash, Dash and Sh."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:66
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Create a private group for the user</emphasis>, if "
"checked will automatically create a group with the same name and the new "
"user as the only member (this may be edited)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:70
msgid ""
"The other options should be obvious. The new user is created immediately "
"after you click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:73
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">2 Add Group</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:75
msgid ""
"You only need to enter the new group name, and if required, the specific "
"group ID."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:78
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">3 Edit</emphasis> (a selected user)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:80
msgid ""
"<guibutton>User Data</guibutton>: Allows you to modify all the data given "
"for the user at creation (the ID can't be changed)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:83
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Account Info</emphasis>:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/userdrake.xml:87
msgid "userdrake2.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:91
msgid ""
"The first option is for setting an expiration date for the account.  "
"Connection is impossible after this date. This is useful for temporary "
"accounts."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:95
msgid ""
"The second option is to lock the account, connection is impossible as long "
"as the account is locked."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:98
msgid "It is also possible to change the icon."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:100
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Password Info</emphasis>: Allows you to set an "
"expiration date for the password, this forces the user to change his "
"password periodically."
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/userdrake.xml:106
msgid "userdrake3.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:110
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Group</emphasis>: Here you can select the groups "
"that the user is a member of."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><note><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:114
msgid ""
"If you are modifying a connected user account, modifications will not be "
"effective until his/her next login."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:118
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">4 Edit</emphasis> (with a group selected)"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:120
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Group Data</emphasis>: Allows you to modify the "
"group name."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:123
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">Group Users</emphasis>: Here you can select the "
"users who are members of the group"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:126
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">5 Delete</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:128
msgid ""
"Select a user or a group and click on <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Delete</emphasis> to remove it. For a user, a window appears "
"to ask if home directory and mailbox must also be deleted. If a private "
"group has been created for the user, it will be deleted as well."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><warning><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:133
msgid "It is possible to delete a group which is not empty."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:136
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">6 Refresh</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:138
msgid ""
"The User database can be changed outside of Userdrake. Click on this icon to "
"refresh the display."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:141
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">7 Guest Account</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/userdrake.xml:143
msgid ""
"<emphasis role=\"bold\">guest</emphasis> is a special account. It is "
"intended to give somebody temporary access to the system with total "
"security. Login is xguest, there is no password, and it is impossible to "
"make modifications to the system from this account. The personal directories "
"are deleted at the end of the session. This account is enabled by default, "
"to disable it, click in the menu on<guimenu> Actions -> Uninstall guest "
"account</guimenu>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><title>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:3
msgid "Set up the graphical server"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><info><subtitle>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:5
msgid "XFdrake"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:10
msgid "XFdrake.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><footnote><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:17
msgid ""
"You can start this tool from the command line, by typing "
"<emphasis>XFdrake</emphasis> as normal user or <emphasis>drakx11</emphasis> "
"as root. Mind the capital letters."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:14
msgid ""
"This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis "
"role=\"bold\">Hardware</emphasis>. Select <emphasis><guilabel>Set up the "
"graphical server</guilabel></emphasis>. <placeholder type=\"footnote\" "
"id=\"0\"/>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:24
msgid "The buttons allow you to change the graphical configuration."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:26
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Graphic card</emphasis>:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:28
msgid ""
"The graphic card currently detected is displayed and the matching server "
"configured. Click on this button to change to another server, for example "
"one with a proprietary driver."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:32
msgid ""
"The available servers are sorted under <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> by "
"manufacturer in alphabetical order and then by model also in alphabetical "
"order. The free drivers are sorted by alphabetical order under<guilabel> "
"Xorg</guilabel>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:38
msgid ""
"In case of problems, <emphasis>Xorg - Vesa</emphasis> will work with most "
"graphic cards and give you time to find and install the right driver while "
"in your Desktop Environment."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:42
msgid ""
"If even Vesa doesn't work, choose <emphasis><guilabel>Xorg</guilabel> - "
"<guilabel>fbdev</guilabel></emphasis>, which is used while installing "
"Mageia, but doesn't allow you to change resolution or refresh rates."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:47
msgid ""
"If you made your choice for a free driver, you may be asked if you want to "
"use a proprietary driver instead with more features (3D effects for "
"example)."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:53
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Monitor:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:55
msgid ""
"In the same way as above, the monitor currently detected is displayed and "
"you can click on the button to change to another one. If the desired monitor "
"isn't in the <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> list, choose in the "
"<guilabel>Generic</guilabel> list a monitor with the same features."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:62
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Resolution:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:64
msgid ""
"This button allows the choice of the resolution (number of pixels) and the "
"colour depth (number of colours). It displays this screen:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Attribute 'fileref' of: <section><para><mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:69
msgid "XFdrake1.png"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:67
msgid ""
"<placeholder type=\"mediaobject\" id=\"0\"/>When you change the color depth, "
"a multi-colored bar will appear next to the second button and show a preview "
"of what the selected color depth looks like."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:75
msgid ""
"The first button shows the currently resolution, click to change for another "
"one. The list gives all the possible choices according to the graphic card "
"and the monitor, it is possible to click on <guilabel>Other</guilabel> to "
"set other resolutions, but bear in mind that you can damage your monitor or "
"select an uncomfortable setting."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:81
msgid ""
"The second button shows the currently colour depth, click to change this for "
"another one."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:85
msgid ""
"Depending on the chosen resolution, it may be necessary to logout and "
"restart the graphical environment for the settings to take effect."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:92
msgid "<emphasis role=\"bold\">Test:</emphasis>"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:94
msgid ""
"Once the configuration done, it is recommended to do a test before clicking "
"on OK because it is easier to modify the settings now than later if the "
"graphical environment doesn't work."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para><note><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:99
msgid ""
"In case of a non working graphical environment, type Alt+Ctrl+F2 to open a "
"text environment, connect as root and type XFdrake (with the caps) to to use "
"XFdrake's text version."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:102
msgid ""
"If the test fails, just wait until the end, if it works but you don't want "
"to change after all, click on <guibutton>No</guibutton>, if everything is "
"right, click on <guibutton role=\"bold\">OK</guibutton>."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><title>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:107
msgid "Options:"
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:110
msgid ""
"<guilabel>Global options</guilabel>: If <emphasis>Disable "
"Ctrl-Alt-Backspace</emphasis> is checked, it will no longer be possible to "
"restart X server using Ctrl+Alt+Backspace keys."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:116
msgid ""
"<guilabel>Graphic card options</guilabel>: Allows you to enable or disable "
"three specific features depending on the graphic card."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><orderedlist><listitem><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:121
msgid ""
"<guilabel>Graphical interface at startup</guilabel>: Most of the time, "
"<emphasis>Automatically start the graphical interface (Xorg) upon "
"booting</emphasis> is checked to make the boot switch to graphical mode, it "
"may be unchecked for a server."
msgstr ""

#. type: Content of: <section><para>
#: en/XFdrake.xml:128
msgid ""
"After a click on the <guibutton>Quit</guibutton> button, the system will ask "
"you to confirm. There is still time to cancel everything and keep the "
"previous configuration, or to accept. In this case, you have to disconnect "
"and reconnect to activate the new configuration."
msgstr ""